1910012317 T1600G CLI

2018-01-11

: Tp-Link 1910012317 T1600G Cli 1910012317_T1600G_CLI 20180111 201801 2018

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 473

Download1910012317 T1600G CLI
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
CLI Reference Guide

T1600G-28TS / T1600G-28PS / T1600G-52TS (TL-SG2452)
T1600G-52PS (TL-SG2452P) / T1600G-18TS (TL-SG2216)
1910012317 REV3.0.0
December 2017

COPYRIGHT & TRADEMARKS
Specifications are subject to change without notice.

is a registered trademark of

TP-Link Technologies Co., Ltd. Other brands and product names are trademarks or registered

trademarks of their respective holders.

No part of the specifications may be reproduced in any form or by any means or used to make
any derivative such as translation, transformation, or adaptation without permission from

TP-Link Technologies Co., Ltd. Copyright © 2017 TP-Link Technologies Co., Ltd. All rights

reserved.

http://www.tp-link.com

I

CONTENTS
Preface

............................................................................................................................ 1

Chapter 1

Using the CLI ................................................................................................... 5

1.1 Accessing the CLI ......................................................................................................................... 5
1.1.1

1.1.2

Logon by Telnet ........................................................................................................... 5
Logon by SSH ............................................................................................................... 6

1.2 CLI Command Modes ................................................................................................................. 11

1.3 Privilege Restrictions .................................................................................................................. 14
1.4 Conventions ................................................................................................................................. 14
1.4.1

Format Conventions .................................................................................................. 14

1.4.3

Parameter Format ...................................................................................................... 15

1.4.2

Chapter 2

Special Characters .................................................................................................... 15

User Interface ............................................................................................... 16

2.1

enable................................................................................................................................... 16

2.3

enable password ................................................................................................................ 17

2.2
2.4
2.5
2.6

2.7

2.8
2.9

2.10

Chapter 3

service password-encryption.......................................................................................... 16
enable secret ...................................................................................................................... 18
configure ............................................................................................................................. 19

exit ........................................................................................................................................ 20

end ........................................................................................................................................ 20
clipaging .............................................................................................................................. 21

history .................................................................................................................................. 21
history clear ........................................................................................................................ 22

User Management Commands ................................................................. 23

3.1

user name (password) ....................................................................................................... 23

3.3

show user account-list ...................................................................................................... 25

3.2
3.4

Chapter 4

user name (secret) ............................................................................................................. 24
show user configuration ................................................................................................... 26

System Configuration Commands .......................................................... 27

4.1

system-time manual .......................................................................................................... 27

4.3

system-time dst predefined............................................................................................. 29

4.2

4.4

4.5

system-time ntp ................................................................................................................. 27

system-time dst date ........................................................................................................ 30
system-time dst recurring ................................................................................................ 31
II

4.6

hostname............................................................................................................................. 32

4.8

contact-info ........................................................................................................................ 33

4.7

4.9

4.10

4.11

4.12
4.13

4.14
4.15
4.16
4.17
4.18

4.19

location ................................................................................................................................ 33
ip address ............................................................................................................................ 34

ip address-alloc .................................................................................................................. 35

reset ..................................................................................................................................... 36
reboot................................................................................................................................... 36

reboot-schedule ................................................................................................................ 37
copy running-config startup-config ............................................................................... 38
copy startup-config tftp ................................................................................................... 38
copy tftp startup-config ................................................................................................... 39
copy backup-config tftp ................................................................................................... 40
copy backup-config startup-config ............................................................................... 40

copy running-config backup-config............................................................................... 41

4.20

copy tftp backup-config ................................................................................................... 41

4.22

boot config .......................................................................................................................... 43

4.21
4.23
4.24

4.25
4.26

4.27
4.28
4.29

4.30

4.31

boot application ................................................................................................................. 42
remove backup-image ...................................................................................................... 43

firmware upgrade ............................................................................................................... 44
ping ....................................................................................................................................... 45

tracert .................................................................................................................................. 46
show system-info............................................................................................................... 47
show image-info ................................................................................................................. 47
show boot ............................................................................................................................ 48

show running-config ......................................................................................................... 48

show startup-config .......................................................................................................... 49

4.32

show system-time ............................................................................................................. 49

4.34

show system-time ntp....................................................................................................... 50

4.36

show cpu-utilization........................................................................................................... 51

4.33

4.35

4.37

Chapter 5
5.1

5.2

show system-time dst ....................................................................................................... 50

show cable-diagnostics interface................................................................................... 51

show memory-utilization .................................................................................................. 52

EEE Configuration Commands ................................................................. 53
eee ........................................................................................................................................ 53

show interface eee ............................................................................................................ 53

III

Chapter 6
6.1

6.2

Chapter 7

SDM Template Commands ........................................................................ 55
sdm prefer ........................................................................................................................... 55

show sdm prefer ................................................................................................................ 56

Time Range Commands ............................................................................. 57

7.1

time-range ........................................................................................................................... 57

7.3

periodic ................................................................................................................................ 58

7.2
7.4

7.5

7.6

7.7

Chapter 8

absolute ............................................................................................................................... 57
holiday (time-range mode) ............................................................................................... 59

holiday .................................................................................................................................. 60

show holiday ....................................................................................................................... 60
show time-range ................................................................................................................ 61

Port Configuration Commands ................................................................ 62

8.1

interface gigabitEthernet.................................................................................................. 62

8.3

description .......................................................................................................................... 63

8.2
8.4

8.5

8.6
8.7

8.8
8.9

8.10

8.11

8.12

Chapter 9
9.1

9.2

interface range gigabitEthernet ...................................................................................... 62
shutdown ............................................................................................................................. 64

flow-control ......................................................................................................................... 65
duplex................................................................................................................................... 65

jumbo-size ........................................................................................................................... 66
speed ................................................................................................................................... 66
clear counters..................................................................................................................... 67
show interface status ........................................................................................................ 68

show interface counters ................................................................................................... 68
show interface configuration ........................................................................................... 69

Port Isolation Commands .......................................................................... 70
port isolation ....................................................................................................................... 70
show port isolation interface ........................................................................................... 71

Chapter 10 Loopback Detection Commands ............................................................. 72
10.1

10.2

10.3

10.4

loopback-detection (global) ............................................................................................. 72

loopback-detection interval ............................................................................................. 72

loopback-detection recovery-time ................................................................................ 73

loopback-detection (interface) ........................................................................................ 74

10.5

loopback-detection config process-mode ................................................................... 74

10.7

show loopback-detection global .................................................................................... 76

10.6

loopback-detection recover ............................................................................................ 75
IV

10.8

show loopback-detection interface ............................................................................... 76

Chapter 11 Etherchannel Commands .......................................................................... 78
11.1

channel-group .................................................................................................................... 78

11.3

lacp system-priority .......................................................................................................... 80

11.2
11.4

port-channel load-balance ............................................................................................... 79
lacp port-priority ................................................................................................................ 81

11.5

show etherchannel ............................................................................................................ 81

11.7

show lacp............................................................................................................................. 83

11.6

11.8

show etherchannel load-balance .................................................................................... 82
show lacp sys-id................................................................................................................. 83

Chapter 12 MAC Address Commands .......................................................................... 85
12.1

mac address-table static .................................................................................................. 85

12.2

mac address-table aging-time ........................................................................................ 86

12.4

mac address-table max-mac-count ............................................................................... 87

12.3

12.5

mac address-table filtering .............................................................................................. 86

show mac address-table .................................................................................................. 89

12.6

clear mac address-table ................................................................................................... 89

12.8

show mac address-table max-mac-count .................................................................... 90

12.7

show mac address-table aging-time .............................................................................. 90

12.9

show mac address-table interface ................................................................................. 91

12.11

show mac address-table address................................................................................... 92

12.10
12.12

show mac address-table count ....................................................................................... 91
show mac address-table vlan .......................................................................................... 93

Chapter 13 IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Commands ................................................................. 94
13.1

vlan ....................................................................................................................................... 94

13.2

name ..................................................................................................................................... 95

13.4

switchport pvid ................................................................................................................... 96

13.6

switchport acceptable frame ........................................................................................... 97

13.3
13.5

13.7

13.8

13.9

13.10

switchport general allowed vlan ...................................................................................... 95
switchport check ingress ................................................................................................. 97

show vlan summary ........................................................................................................... 98

show vlan brief.................................................................................................................... 99

show vlan ............................................................................................................................. 99
show interface switchport .............................................................................................. 100

V

Chapter 14 MAC-based VLAN Commands ................................................................ 101
14.1

mac-vlan mac-address ................................................................................................... 101

14.2

mac-vlan ............................................................................................................................ 102

14.4

show mac-vlan interface ................................................................................................ 103

14.3

show mac-vlan.................................................................................................................. 102

Chapter 15 Protocol-based VLAN Commands ........................................................ 104
15.1

protocol-vlan template ................................................................................................... 104

15.2

protocol-vlan vlan ............................................................................................................ 105

15.4

show protocol-vlan template ......................................................................................... 106

15.3

15.5

protocol-vlan group......................................................................................................... 106

show protocol-vlan vlan.................................................................................................. 107

Chapter 16 GVRP Commands ....................................................................................... 108
16.1

gvrp..................................................................................................................................... 108

16.2

gvrp (interface) ................................................................................................................. 108

16.4

gvrp timer .......................................................................................................................... 110

16.3

16.5

16.6

gvrp registration............................................................................................................... 109

show gvrp interface ......................................................................................................... 111

show gvrp global .............................................................................................................. 112

Chapter 17 IGMP Snooping Commands..................................................................... 113
17.1

ip igmp snooping (global)................................................................................................ 113

17.2

ip igmp snooping version ............................................................................................... 113

17.4

ip igmp snooping header-validation ............................................................................. 115

17.6

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (immediate-leave) ....................................................... 117

17.3

17.5

17.7

17.8

ip igmp snooping drop-unknown .................................................................................. 114

ip igmp snooping vlan-config ........................................................................................ 115

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (report-suppression) .................................................. 117

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (router-ports-forbidden) ............................................ 118

17.9

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (rport interface) ........................................................... 119

17.11

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (querier) ........................................................................ 121

17.10

17.12
17.13

17.14
17.15

17.16

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (static) ........................................................................... 120

ip igmp snooping (interface) .......................................................................................... 122

ip igmp snooping max-groups ....................................................................................... 123

ip igmp snooping immediate-leave............................................................................... 124

ip igmp profile ................................................................................................................... 124
deny .................................................................................................................................... 125
VI

17.17

permit ................................................................................................................................. 125

17.19

ip igmp filter ...................................................................................................................... 127

17.18
17.20
17.21
17.22
17.23
17.24

17.25

range .................................................................................................................................. 126

clear ip igmp snooping statistics .................................................................................. 127
show ip igmp snooping ................................................................................................... 128
show ip igmp snooping interface .................................................................................. 128
show ip igmp snooping vlan ........................................................................................... 129

show ip igmp snooping groups ..................................................................................... 130
show ip igmp profile......................................................................................................... 131

Chapter 18 MLD Snooping Commands ...................................................................... 132
18.1

18.2

18.3

18.4

18.5

18.6

18.7

18.8

ipv6 mld snooping (global).............................................................................................. 132

ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown ................................................................................ 132

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config ...................................................................................... 133

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (immediate-leave) ..................................................... 134

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (report-suppression) ................................................ 135

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (router-ports-forbidden) .......................................... 136

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (rport interface) ......................................................... 137

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (static) ......................................................................... 137

18.9

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (querier) ...................................................................... 138

18.11

ipv6 mld snooping max-groups ..................................................................................... 140

18.10

ipv6 mld snooping (interface) ........................................................................................ 140

18.12

ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave ............................................................................ 141

18.14

deny .................................................................................................................................... 143

18.13
18.15

18.16
18.17

ipv6 mld profile ................................................................................................................. 142
permit ................................................................................................................................. 143
range .................................................................................................................................. 144
ipv6 mld filter .................................................................................................................... 144

18.18

clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics ................................................................................ 145

18.20

show ipv6 mld snooping interface ................................................................................ 146

18.19
18.21

18.22
18.23

show ipv6 mld snooping ................................................................................................. 145

show ipv6 mld snooping vlan ......................................................................................... 147
show ipv6 mld snooping groups ................................................................................... 147

show ipv6 mld profile ...................................................................................................... 148

Chapter 19 MVR Commands ......................................................................................... 149
19.1

19.2

mvr (global) ........................................................................................................................ 149

mvr group .......................................................................................................................... 149
VII

19.3

mvr mode........................................................................................................................... 150

19.4

mvr querytime................................................................................................................... 151

19.6

mvr (interface)................................................................................................................... 152

19.5
19.7

19.8

mvr vlan.............................................................................................................................. 152
mvr type ............................................................................................................................. 153
mvr immediate .................................................................................................................. 154

19.9

mvr vlan (group) ................................................................................................................ 154

19.11

show mvr interface .......................................................................................................... 156

19.10
19.12

19.13

show mvr ........................................................................................................................... 155
show mvr members ......................................................................................................... 156

show mvr traffic................................................................................................................ 157

Chapter 20 MSTP Commands ....................................................................................... 158
20.1

20.2

20.3

20.4

20.5

debug spanning-tree ....................................................................................................... 158

spanning-tree (global) ..................................................................................................... 159

spanning-tree (interface) ................................................................................................ 159

spanning-tree common-config ..................................................................................... 160

spanning-tree mode ........................................................................................................ 161

20.6

spanning-tree mst configuration .................................................................................. 162

20.8

name ................................................................................................................................... 163

20.7

instance ............................................................................................................................. 162

20.9

revision .............................................................................................................................. 164

20.11

spanning-tree mst ........................................................................................................... 165

20.10

20.12

20.13

20.14

20.15

spanning-tree mst instance ........................................................................................... 165

spanning-tree priority ..................................................................................................... 166

spanning-tree timer ......................................................................................................... 167

spanning-tree hold-count .............................................................................................. 168

spanning-tree max-hops ................................................................................................ 168

20.16

spanning-tree bpdufilter ................................................................................................. 169

20.18

spanning-tree bpduguard .............................................................................................. 170

20.17

spanning-tree bpduflood................................................................................................ 170

20.19

spanning-tree guard loop ............................................................................................... 171

20.21

spanning-tree guard tc ................................................................................................... 172

20.20

spanning-tree guard root ............................................................................................... 172

20.22

spanning-tree mcheck .................................................................................................... 173

20.24

show spanning-tree bridge ............................................................................................ 174

20.23
20.25

show spanning-tree active ............................................................................................. 173

show spanning-tree interface........................................................................................ 174
VIII

20.26

20.27

show spanning-tree interface-security ....................................................................... 175

show spanning-tree mst ................................................................................................. 176

Chapter 21 LLDP Commands........................................................................................ 178
21.1

lldp ...................................................................................................................................... 178

21.3

lldp hold-multiplier ........................................................................................................... 179

21.2

21.4

lldp forward_message ..................................................................................................... 178

lldp timer ............................................................................................................................ 180

21.5

lldp receive ........................................................................................................................ 181

21.7

lldp snmp-trap .................................................................................................................. 182

21.6

21.8

lldp transmit ...................................................................................................................... 181

lldp tlv-select .................................................................................................................... 183

21.9

lldp management-address ............................................................................................. 183

21.11

lldp med-status ................................................................................................................ 185

21.10
21.12
21.13
21.14
21.15
21.16

21.17
21.18

lldp med-fast-count ......................................................................................................... 184
lldp med-tlv-select ........................................................................................................... 185
lldp med-location ............................................................................................................. 186

show lldp ............................................................................................................................ 187
show lldp interface........................................................................................................... 187
show lldp local-information interface ........................................................................... 188

show lldp neighbor-information interface ................................................................... 189

show lldp traffic interface ............................................................................................... 189

Chapter 22 Static Routes Commands ........................................................................ 191
22.1

22.2

22.3

22.4

22.5

22.6

22.7

22.8

22.9

ip routing............................................................................................................................ 191

interface vlan .................................................................................................................... 191

interface loopback ........................................................................................................... 192

switchport ......................................................................................................................... 192

interface range port-channel ......................................................................................... 193

description ........................................................................................................................ 194

shutdown ........................................................................................................................... 194

interface port-channel .................................................................................................... 195

ip route ............................................................................................................................... 196

22.10

ipv6 routing ....................................................................................................................... 196

22.12

show interface vlan .......................................................................................................... 198

22.11

22.13
22.14

ipv6 route .......................................................................................................................... 197
show ip interface .............................................................................................................. 198
show ip interface brief..................................................................................................... 199
IX

22.15

show ip route .................................................................................................................... 199

22.16

show ip route specify ...................................................................................................... 200

22.18

show ipv6 interface ......................................................................................................... 201

22.17
22.19
22.20

show ip route summary................................................................................................... 201
show ipv6 route ................................................................................................................ 202
show ipv6 route summary .............................................................................................. 202

Chapter 23 IPv6 Address Configuration Commands ............................................. 204
23.1

ipv6 enable ........................................................................................................................ 204

23.2

ipv6 address autoconfig ................................................................................................. 204

23.4

ipv6 address dhcp ........................................................................................................... 206

23.6

ipv6 address eui-64 ......................................................................................................... 207

23.3
23.5

23.7

23.8

ipv6 address link-local .................................................................................................... 205

ipv6 address ra ................................................................................................................. 206

ipv6 address ..................................................................................................................... 208
show ipv6 interface ......................................................................................................... 209

Chapter 24 ARP Commands .......................................................................................... 210
24.1

arp ....................................................................................................................................... 210

24.3

arp dynamicrenew ........................................................................................................... 211

24.2
24.4

24.5

24.6

24.7

24.8

clear arp-cache ................................................................................................................ 211
arp timeout ........................................................................................................................ 212
gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable ............................................................................ 212

gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable ....................................................................... 213

gratuitous-arp learning enable ...................................................................................... 213

gratuitous-arp send-interval .......................................................................................... 214

24.9

ip proxy-arp ....................................................................................................................... 215

24.11

show arp ............................................................................................................................ 216

24.10
24.12
24.13
24.14

24.15

ip local-proxy-arp ............................................................................................................. 215
show ip arp (interface) ..................................................................................................... 217
show ip arp summary ...................................................................................................... 217
show gratuitous-arp ........................................................................................................ 218

show ip proxy-arp ............................................................................................................ 218

Chapter 25 DHCP Server Commands ......................................................................... 220
25.1

25.2

25.3

25.4

service dhcp server ......................................................................................................... 220

ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip .............................................................. 220

ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id ........................................................... 221

ip dhcp server exclude-address ................................................................................... 222
X

25.5

ip dhcp server pool .......................................................................................................... 222

25.7

ip dhcp server ping packets ........................................................................................... 224

25.6
25.8
25.9

ip dhcp server ping timeout ........................................................................................... 223
network .............................................................................................................................. 224
lease ................................................................................................................................... 225

25.10

address hardware-address ............................................................................................ 226

25.12

default-gateway ............................................................................................................... 227

25.11
25.13
25.14

25.15

address client-identifier.................................................................................................. 226
dns-server ......................................................................................................................... 228
netbios-name-server ...................................................................................................... 229

netbios-node-type........................................................................................................... 229

25.16

next-server ........................................................................................................................ 230

25.18

bootfile ............................................................................................................................... 231

25.20

show ip dhcp server statistics ....................................................................................... 232

25.17

25.19
25.21

domain-name.................................................................................................................... 231

show ip dhcp server status ............................................................................................ 232

show ip dhcp server extend-option.............................................................................. 233

25.22

show ip dhcp server pool ............................................................................................... 233

25.24

show ip dhcp server manual-binding ........................................................................... 234

25.26

clear ip dhcp server statistics........................................................................................ 235

25.23

25.25
25.27

show ip dhcp server excluded-address....................................................................... 234

show ip dhcp server binding .......................................................................................... 235
clear ip dhcp server binding ........................................................................................... 236

Chapter 26 DHCP Relay Commands ........................................................................... 237
26.1

26.2

service dhcp relay ............................................................................................................ 237

ip dhcp relay hops ............................................................................................................ 237

26.3

ip dhcp relay time ............................................................................................................. 238

26.5

ip dhcp relay information ................................................................................................ 239

26.7

ip dhcp relay information format ................................................................................... 241

26.4
26.6

26.8

ip helper-address ............................................................................................................. 239

ip dhcp relay information strategy ................................................................................ 240

ip dhcp relay information circuit-id ............................................................................... 242

26.9

ip dhcp relay information remote-id ............................................................................. 242

26.11

ip dhcp relay vlan ............................................................................................................. 244

26.10
26.12

ip dhcp relay default-interface ...................................................................................... 243
show ip dhcp relay ........................................................................................................... 244

XI

Chapter 27 DHCP L2 Relay Commands ..................................................................... 246
27.1

27.2

27.3

27.4

27.5

27.6

ip dhcp l2relay .................................................................................................................. 246

ip dhcp l2relay vlan .......................................................................................................... 246

ip dhcp l2relay information ............................................................................................. 247

ip dhcp l2relay information strategy............................................................................. 247

ip dhcp l2relay information format ................................................................................ 248

ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id............................................................................ 249

27.7

ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id .......................................................................... 250

27.9

show ip dhcp l2relay interface ....................................................................................... 251

27.8

show ip dhcp l2relay ........................................................................................................ 250

Chapter 28 QoS Commands.......................................................................................... 252
28.1

qos trust mode ................................................................................................................. 252

28.2

qos port-priority ............................................................................................................... 253

28.4

qos dot1p-remap ............................................................................................................. 254

28.3

qos cos-map ..................................................................................................................... 253

28.5

qos dscp-map................................................................................................................... 255

28.7

qos queue mode .............................................................................................................. 256

28.9

show qos dot1p-remap .................................................................................................. 258

28.6
28.8

qos dscp-remap ............................................................................................................... 256

show qos cos-map .......................................................................................................... 257

28.10

show qos dscp-map ........................................................................................................ 258

28.12

show qos port-priority interface ................................................................................... 259

28.11
28.13

28.14

show qos dscp-remap .................................................................................................... 259
show qos trust interface ................................................................................................. 260
show qos queue interface .............................................................................................. 260

Chapter 29 Bandwidth Control Commands .............................................................. 262
29.1

29.2

29.3

29.4

29.5

29.6

29.7

storm-control rate-mode ............................................................................................... 262

storm-control.................................................................................................................... 262

storm-control exceed ..................................................................................................... 263

storm-control recover .................................................................................................... 264

bandwidth .......................................................................................................................... 265

show storm-control ......................................................................................................... 266
show bandwidth ............................................................................................................... 266

Chapter 30 Voice VLAN Commands ........................................................................... 268
30.1

voice vlan ........................................................................................................................... 268
XII

30.2

voice vlan (interface) ....................................................................................................... 268

30.4

voice vlan oui .................................................................................................................... 270

30.3

voice vlan priority ............................................................................................................. 269

30.5

show voice vlan ................................................................................................................ 270

30.7

show voice vlan interface ............................................................................................... 271

30.6

show voice vlan oui-table ............................................................................................... 271

Chapter 31 Auto VoIP Commands ............................................................................... 273
31.1

31.2

31.3

31.4

31.5

auto-voip ........................................................................................................................... 273

auto-voip (interface) ........................................................................................................ 273

auto-voip dot1p................................................................................................................ 274

auto-voip untagged ......................................................................................................... 275

auto-voip none ................................................................................................................. 275

31.6

no auto-voip (interface)................................................................................................... 276

31.8

auto-voip data priority..................................................................................................... 277

31.7

31.9

auto-voip dscp ................................................................................................................. 276

show auto-voip ................................................................................................................. 277

Chapter 32 Access Control Commands .................................................................... 279
32.1

32.2

32.3

32.4

32.5

32.6

user access-control ip-based enable .......................................................................... 279

user access-control ip-based ....................................................................................... 279

user access-control mac-based enable ...................................................................... 280

user access-control mac-based ................................................................................... 281

user access-control port-based enable ...................................................................... 282
user access-control port-based ................................................................................... 282

Chapter 33 HTTP and HTTPS Commands ................................................................. 284
33.1

33.2

33.3

33.4

33.5

33.6

33.7

33.8

33.9

ip http server ..................................................................................................................... 284

ip http port ......................................................................................................................... 284

ip http max-users ............................................................................................................. 285

ip http session timeout ................................................................................................... 286

ip http secure-server ....................................................................................................... 287

ip http secure-port........................................................................................................... 287

ip http secure-protocol ................................................................................................... 288

ip http secure-ciphersuite .............................................................................................. 289

ip http secure-max-users ............................................................................................... 289

33.10

ip http secure-session timeout ..................................................................................... 290

33.12

ip http secure-server download key ............................................................................. 292

33.11

ip http secure-server download certificate ................................................................. 291

XIII

33.13

33.14

show ip http configuration.............................................................................................. 293

show ip http secure-server ............................................................................................ 293

Chapter 34 SSH Commands .......................................................................................... 295
34.1

ip ssh server ...................................................................................................................... 295

34.2

ip ssh port .......................................................................................................................... 295

34.4

ip ssh algorithm ................................................................................................................ 297

34.3

ip ssh version .................................................................................................................... 296

34.5

ip ssh timeout ................................................................................................................... 297

34.7

ip ssh download................................................................................................................ 299

34.6

34.8

34.9

ip ssh max-client .............................................................................................................. 298

remove public-key ........................................................................................................... 299

show ip ssh ........................................................................................................................ 300

Chapter 35 Telnet Commands...................................................................................... 301
35.1

35.2

35.3

telnet enable ..................................................................................................................... 301

telnet port .......................................................................................................................... 301
show telnet-status ........................................................................................................... 302

Chapter 36 AAA Commands ......................................................................................... 303
36.1

36.2

36.3

36.4

36.5

36.6

36.7

36.8

36.9

tacacas-server host ........................................................................................................ 303

show tacacs-server ......................................................................................................... 304

radius-server host ........................................................................................................... 305

show radius-server .......................................................................................................... 306

aaa group........................................................................................................................... 307

server ................................................................................................................................. 308

show aaa group ................................................................................................................ 308

aaa authentication login.................................................................................................. 309

aaa authentication enable .............................................................................................. 310

36.10

aaa authentication dot1x default................................................................................... 311

36.12

show aaa authentication ................................................................................................. 312

36.11
36.13
36.14

36.15
36.16
36.17
36.18
36.19

aaa accounting dot1x default ........................................................................................ 312

show aaa accounting....................................................................................................... 313

line telnet ........................................................................................................................... 313
login authentication (telnet)............................................................................................ 314
line ssh ............................................................................................................................... 315
login authentication (ssh)................................................................................................ 315
enable authentication (telnet) ........................................................................................ 316
enable authentication (ssh) ............................................................................................ 317
XIV

36.20

ip http login authentication............................................................................................. 317

36.21

ip http enable authentication ......................................................................................... 318

36.23

enable-admin .................................................................................................................... 319

36.22

show aaa global ................................................................................................................ 319

Chapter 37 IEEE 802.1x Commands ............................................................................ 321
37.1

37.2

dot1x system-auth-control ............................................................................................ 321

dot1x handshake.............................................................................................................. 322

37.3

dot1x auth-protocol ........................................................................................................ 322

37.5

dot1x accounting ............................................................................................................. 324

37.4

dot1x vlan-assignment ................................................................................................... 323

37.6

dot1x mab ......................................................................................................................... 325

37.8

dot1x timeout quiet-period ............................................................................................ 326

37.10

dot1x max- req ................................................................................................................. 328

37.7
37.9

dot1x guest-vlan .............................................................................................................. 325

dot1x timeout supp-timeout .......................................................................................... 327

37.11

dot1x .................................................................................................................................. 328

37.13

dot1x port-method .......................................................................................................... 330

37.12
37.14
37.15

37.16
37.17
37.18

dot1x port-control ........................................................................................................... 329
dot1x auth-init .................................................................................................................. 331

dot1x auth-reauth ............................................................................................................ 331
show dot1x global ............................................................................................................ 332
show dot1x interface....................................................................................................... 333
show dot1x auth-state .................................................................................................... 333

Chapter 38 Port Security Commands......................................................................... 335
38.1

38.2

mac address-table max-mac count.............................................................................. 335

show mac address-table max-mac-count .................................................................. 335

Chapter 39 Port Mirroring Commands ....................................................................... 337
39.1

monitor session destination interface ......................................................................... 337

39.3

show monitor session ..................................................................................................... 339

39.2

monitor session source .................................................................................................. 338

Chapter 40 ACL Commands .......................................................................................... 341
40.1

access-list create ............................................................................................................ 341

40.2

access-list resequence .................................................................................................. 341

40.4

access-list ip ..................................................................................................................... 343

40.3

access-list mac ................................................................................................................ 342

XV

40.5

40.6

40.7

40.8

access-list ipv6 ................................................................................................................ 345

access-list action ............................................................................................................. 347

redirect interface ............................................................................................................. 348

s-condition ........................................................................................................................ 348

40.9

s-mirror .............................................................................................................................. 349

40.11

access bind ....................................................................................................................... 351

40.13

show access-list bind...................................................................................................... 352

40.10
40.12
40.14
40.15

40.16

qos-remark........................................................................................................................ 350

show access-list .............................................................................................................. 352
show access-list status .................................................................................................. 353

show access-list counter ............................................................................................... 353
clear access-list ............................................................................................................... 354

Chapter 41 IPv4 IMPB Commands ............................................................................... 355
41.1

41.2

41.3

ip source binding.............................................................................................................. 355

ip dhcp snooping ............................................................................................................. 356

ip dhcp snooping vlan ..................................................................................................... 357

41.4

ip dhcp snooping max-entries ....................................................................................... 357

41.6

show ip dhcp snooping ................................................................................................... 359

41.5

41.7

show ip source binding ................................................................................................... 358

show ip dhcp snooping interface .................................................................................. 359

Chapter 42 IPv6 IMPB Commands ............................................................................... 361
42.1

42.2

42.3

Ipv6 source binding ......................................................................................................... 361

ipv6 dhcp snooping ......................................................................................................... 362

ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan ................................................................................................. 363

42.4

ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries .................................................................................. 363

42.6

ipv6 nd snooping vlan ..................................................................................................... 365

42.8

show ipv6 source binding............................................................................................... 366

42.5

42.7

ipv6 nd snooping.............................................................................................................. 364

ipv6 nd snooping max-entries ....................................................................................... 365

42.9

show ipv6 dhcp snooping............................................................................................... 367

42.11

show ipv6 nd snooping ................................................................................................... 368

42.10

show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface ............................................................................. 367

Chapter 43 IP Verify Source Commands ................................................................... 369
43.1

43.2

43.3

ip verify source ................................................................................................................. 369

ip verify source logging................................................................................................... 370

show ip verify source ...................................................................................................... 370
XVI

43.4

show ip verify source interface ..................................................................................... 371

Chapter 44 IPv6 Verify Source Commands .............................................................. 372
44.1

44.2

44.3

ipv6 verify source............................................................................................................. 372

show ipv6 verify source .................................................................................................. 373

show ipv6 verify source interface ................................................................................. 373

Chapter 45 DHCPv4 Filter Commands ....................................................................... 375
45.1

45.2

45.3

45.4

45.5

45.6

45.7

45.8

45.9

ip dhcp filter ...................................................................................................................... 375

ip dhcp filter (interface) ................................................................................................... 375

ip dhcp filter mac-verify .................................................................................................. 376

ip dhcp filter limit rate ...................................................................................................... 377

ip dhcp filter decline rate ................................................................................................ 378

ip dhcp filter server permit-entry .................................................................................. 378

show ip dhcp filter ............................................................................................................ 379

show ip dhcp filter interface ........................................................................................... 380

show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry........................................................................ 380

Chapter 46 DHCPv6 Filter Commands ....................................................................... 382
46.1

46.2

ipv6 dhcp filter .................................................................................................................. 382

ipv6 dhcp filter (interface)............................................................................................... 382

46.3

ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate ................................................................................................. 383

46.5

ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry .............................................................................. 385

46.4

ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate............................................................................................ 384

46.6

show ipv6 dhcp filter ....................................................................................................... 386

46.8

show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry........................................................................ 387

46.7

show ipv6 dhcp filter interface ...................................................................................... 386

Chapter 47 DoS Defend Commands ........................................................................... 388
47.1

47.2

47.3

ip dos-prevent .................................................................................................................. 388

ip dos-prevent type ......................................................................................................... 388

show ip dos-prevent........................................................................................................ 390

Chapter 48 DLDP Commands ....................................................................................... 392
48.1

48.2

48.3

48.4

48.5

dldp (global) ....................................................................................................................... 392

dldp interval....................................................................................................................... 392

dldp shut-mode ................................................................................................................ 393

dldp(interface) .................................................................................................................. 394
show dldp .......................................................................................................................... 394
XVII

48.6

show dldp interface ......................................................................................................... 395

Chapter 49 SNMP Commands ...................................................................................... 396
49.1

49.2

49.3

49.4

49.5

49.6

snmp-server...................................................................................................................... 396

snmp-server view ............................................................................................................ 396

snmp-server group .......................................................................................................... 397

snmp-server user............................................................................................................. 399

snmp-server community ................................................................................................ 400

snmp-server host............................................................................................................. 401

49.7

snmp-server engineID .................................................................................................... 403

49.9

snmp-server traps ........................................................................................................... 404

49.8

49.10

49.11

49.12

49.13

49.14

49.15

49.16

snmp-server traps snmp ................................................................................................ 403

snmp-server traps ddm .................................................................................................. 406

snmp-server traps vlan ................................................................................................... 407

snmp-server traps security ............................................................................................ 408

snmp-server traps acl ..................................................................................................... 409

snmp-server traps ip ....................................................................................................... 409

snmp-server traps power ............................................................................................... 410

snmp-server traps link-status ....................................................................................... 411

49.17

rmon history ...................................................................................................................... 412

49.19

rmon alarm ........................................................................................................................ 414

49.18
49.20

49.21

rmon event ........................................................................................................................ 413
rmon statistics .................................................................................................................. 415
show snmp-server ........................................................................................................... 416

49.22

show snmp-server view .................................................................................................. 416

49.24

show snmp-server user .................................................................................................. 417

49.26

show snmp-server host .................................................................................................. 418

49.28

show rmon history ........................................................................................................... 419

49.23
49.25

49.27

show snmp-server group ............................................................................................... 417

show snmp-server community ...................................................................................... 418

show snmp-server engineID .......................................................................................... 419

49.29

show rmon event.............................................................................................................. 420

49.31

show rmon statistics ....................................................................................................... 421

49.30

show rmon alarm .............................................................................................................. 420

Chapter 50 PoE Commands .......................................................................................... 422
50.1

50.2

power inline consumption (global) ................................................................................ 422

power profile ..................................................................................................................... 422
XVIII

50.3

power inline consumption (interface) ........................................................................... 423

50.4

power inline priority ......................................................................................................... 424

50.6

power inline profile........................................................................................................... 425

50.5
50.7

50.8

50.9

50.10
50.11

power inline supply .......................................................................................................... 425
power inline time-range .................................................................................................. 426

show power inline ............................................................................................................ 427
show power inline configuration interface .................................................................. 427
show power inline information interface...................................................................... 428

show power profile .......................................................................................................... 428

Chapter 51 ARP Inspection Commands ..................................................................... 429
51.1

51.2

ip arp inspection ............................................................................................................... 429

ip arp inspection validate ................................................................................................ 429

51.3

ip arp inspection vlan ...................................................................................................... 430

51.5

ip arp inspection trust ..................................................................................................... 432

51.7

ip arp inspection burst-interval ..................................................................................... 433

51.4
51.6

51.8

51.9

ip arp inspection vlan logging ........................................................................................ 431

ip arp inspection limit-rate.............................................................................................. 432

ip arp inspection recover ................................................................................................ 434

show ip arp inspection .................................................................................................... 434

51.10

show ip arp inspection interface ................................................................................... 435

51.12

show ip arp inspection statistics ................................................................................... 436

51.11
51.13

show ip arp inspection vlan ............................................................................................ 436

clear ip arp inspection statistics ................................................................................... 437

Chapter 52 ND Detection Commands ........................................................................ 438
52.1

ipv6 nd detection ............................................................................................................. 438

52.2

ipv6 nd detection vlan ..................................................................................................... 438

52.4

ipv6 nd detection trust .................................................................................................... 439

52.6

show ipv6 nd detection interface.................................................................................. 440

52.3
52.5

52.7

ipv6 nd detection vlan logging....................................................................................... 439

show ipv6 nd detection ................................................................................................... 440

show ipv6 nd detection vlan .......................................................................................... 441

Chapter 53 System Log Commands ........................................................................... 442
53.1

53.2

53.3

53.4

logging buffer ................................................................................................................... 442

logging buffer level .......................................................................................................... 442

logging file flash ............................................................................................................... 443

logging file flash frequency ............................................................................................ 444
XIX

53.5

logging file flash level ...................................................................................................... 445

53.6

logging host index............................................................................................................ 445

53.8

logging console level....................................................................................................... 447

53.7

logging console ................................................................................................................ 446

53.9

logging monitor ................................................................................................................ 448

53.11

clear logging ..................................................................................................................... 449

53.10
53.12

logging monitor level ....................................................................................................... 448
show logging local-config .............................................................................................. 450

53.13

show logging loghost ...................................................................................................... 450

53.15

show logging flash ........................................................................................................... 451

53.14

show logging buffer ......................................................................................................... 451

XX

Preface
This Guide is intended for network administrator to provide referenced information about CLI
(Command Line Interface). The device mentioned in this Guide stands for T1600G-28TS/
T1600G-52TS/ T1600G-28MPS/T1600G-18TS JetStream Gigabit L2 Managed Switch without
any explanation. The commands in this guide apply to these models if not specially noted, and
T1600G-28TS is taken as an example model in the example commands.
Some models featured in this guide may be unavailable in your country or region. For local
sales information, visit http://www.tp-link.com.

Overview of this Guide
Chapter 1: Using the CLI

Provide information about how to use the CLI, CLI Command Modes, Security Levels and some
Conventions.

Chapter 2: User Interface
Provide information about the commands used to switch between five CLI Command Modes.
Chapter 3: User Management Commands
Provide information about the commands used for user management.
Chapter 4: System Configuration Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the System information and
System IP, reboot and reset the switch, upgrade the switch system and commands used for
cable test.

Chapter 5: EEE Configuration Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring EEE.
Chapter 6: SDM Template Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the SDM templates.
Chapter 7: Time Range Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the time range.
Chapter 8: Port Configuration Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Speed, Negotiation Mode,
and Flow Control for Ethernet ports.

Chapter 9: Port Isolation Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring Port Isolation function.
Chapter 10: Loopback Detection Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Loopback Detection
function.

1

Chapter 11: Etherchannel Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring LAG (Link Aggregation Group)
and LACP (Link Aggregation Control Protocol).
Chapter 12: MAC Address Commands
Provide information about the commands used for Address configuration.
Chapter 13: IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring IEEE 802.1Q VLAN.
Chapter 14: MAC-based VLAN Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring MAC-based VLAN.
Chapter 15: Protocol-based VLAN Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring Protocol VLAN.
Chapter 16: GVRP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring GVRP (GARP VLAN registration
protocol).

Chapter 17: IGMP Snooping Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the IGMP Snooping (Internet
Group Management Protocol Snooping).

Chapter 18: MLD Snooping Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the MLD Snooping (Multicast
Listener Discovery Snooping).
Chapter 19: MVR Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the MVR.
Chapter 20: MSTP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the MSTP (Multiple Spanning
Tree Protocol).

Chapter 21: LLDP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring LLDP function.
Chapter 22: Static Routes Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Static Route function.
Chapter 23: IPv6 Address Configuration Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the System IPv6 addresses.
Chapter 24: ARP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the ARP (Address Resolution
Protocol) functions.

2

Chapter 25: DHCP Server Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCP Server function.
Chapter 26: DHCP Relay Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCP Relay function.
Chapter 27: DHCP L2 Relay Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCP L2 Relay function.
Chapter 28: QoS Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the QoS function.
Chapter 29: Bandwidth Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Bandwidth Control.
Chapter 30: Voice VLAN Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring Voice VLAN.
Chapter 31 Auto VoIP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring Auto VoIP.
Chapter 32: Access Control Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring Access Control.
Chapter 33: HTTP and HTTPS Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the HTTP and HTTPS logon.
Chapter 34: SSH Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring and managing SSH (Security

Shell).

Chapter 35: Telnet Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring and managing SSH (Security

Shell).

Chapter 36: AAA Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring AAA (authentication,
authorization and accounting).

Chapter 37: IEEE 802.1X Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring IEEE 802.1X function.
Chapter 38 Port Security Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring Port Security.
Chapter 39: Port Mirroring Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the Port Mirror function.

3

Chapter 40: ACL Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the ACL (Access Control List).
Chapter 41: IPv4 IMPB Commands
Provide information about the commands used for binding the IP address, MAC address, VLAN
and the connected Port number of the Host together.
Chapter 42: IPv6 IMPB Commands
Provide information about the commands used for binding the IPv6 address, MAC address,
VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host together.
Chapter 43: IP Verify Source Commands
Provide information about the commands used for guarding the IP Source by filtering the IP
packets based on the IP-MAC Binding entries.
Chapter 44: IPv6 Verify Source Commands
Provide information about the commands used for guarding the IPv6 Source by filtering the IP
packets based on the IP-MAC Binding entries.
Chapter 45: DHCPv4 Filter Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCPv4 Filter.
Chapter 46: DHCPv6 Filter Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DHCPv6 Filter.
Chapter 47: DoS Defend Command
Provide information about the commands used for DoS defend and detecting the DoS attack.
Chapter 48: DLDP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the DLDP (Device Link
Detection Protocol).

Chapter 49: SNMP Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring the SNMP (Simple Network
Management Protocol) functions.

Chapter 50: PoE Commands (For T1600G-28MPS only)
Provide information about the commands used for configuring PoE function.
Chapter 51: ARP Inspection Commands
Provide information about the commands used for protecting the switch from the ARP
cheating or ARP Attack.

Chapter 52: ND Detection Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring ND detection.
Chapter 53: System Log Commands
Provide information about the commands used for configuring system log.
4

Chapter 1

Using the CLI

1.1 Accessing the CLI
You can log on to the switch and access the CLI by logging on to the switch remotely by a
Telnet or SSH connection through an Ethernet port.

1.1.1 Logon by Telnet
To log on to the switch by a Telnet connection, please take the following steps:
1.

Click Start and type in cmd in the Search programs and files window and press the Enter
button.

Figure 1-1 Run Window
2.

Type in telnet 192.168.0.1 in the cmd window and press Enter.

Figure 1-2 Type in the telnet command

5

3.

Type in the login username and password (both admin by default). Press Enter and you will
enter User EXEC Mode.

Figure 1-2 Log in the Switch
4.

Type in enable command and you will enter Privileged EXEC Mode.

By default no

password is needed. Later you can set a password for users who want to access the
Privileged EXEC Mode.

Figure 1-3 Enter into Priviledged EXEC Mode

1.1.2 Logon by SSH
To log on by SSH, a Putty client software is recommended. There are two authentication modes
to set up an SSH connection:

Password Authentication Mode: It requires username and password, which are both admin by
default.
Key Authentication Mode: It requires a public key for the switch and a private key for the SSH
client software. You can generate the public key and the private key through Putty Key
Generator.
Note:

Before SSH login, please follow the steps shown in Figure 1-4 to enable the SSH function
through Telnet connection.

6

Figure 1-4 Enable SSH function


Password Authentication Mode

1.

Open the software to log on to the interface of PuTTY. Enter the IP address of the switch
into Host Name field; keep the default value 22 in the Port field; select SSH as the
Connection type.

Figure 1-5 SSH Connection Config

7

2.

Click the Open button in the above figure to log on to the switch. Enter the login user name

and password to log on the switch, and then enter enable to enter Privileged EXEC Mode,
so you can continue to configure the switch.

Figure 1-6 Log on the Switch


Key Authentication Mode

1.

Select the key type and key length, and generate SSH key.

Figure 1-7 Generate SSH Key

1.
2.

Note:

The key length is in the range of 512 to 3072 bits.

During the key generation, randomly moving the mouse quickly can accelerate the key

generation.

8

2.

After the key is successfully generated, please save the public key and private key to a
TFTP server.

Figure 1-8 Save the Generated Key
3.

Log on to the switch by Telnet and download the public key file from the TFTP server to the
switch, as the following figure shows:

Figure 1-9 Download the Public Key

9

Note:

1.

The key type should accord with the type of the key file.

4.

After the public key is downloaded, please log on to the interface of PuTTY and enter the IP

2.

The SSH key downloading can not be interrupted.
address for login.

Figure 1-10 SSH Connection Config

10

5.

Click Browse to download the private key file to SSH client software and click Open.

Figure 1-11 Download the Private Key
6.

After successful authentication, please enter the login user name. If you log on to the
switch without entering password, it indicates that the key has been successfully
downloaded.

Figure 1-12 Log on the Switch

1.2 CLI Command Modes
The CLI is divided into different command modes: User EXEC Mode, Privileged EXEC Mode,
Global Configuration Mode, Interface Configuration Mode and VLAN Configuration Mode.

11

Interface Configuration Mode can also be divided into Interface Ethernet, Interface
link-aggregation and some other modes, which is shown as the following diagram.

The following table gives detailed information about the Accessing path, Prompt of each mode
and how to exit the current mode and access the next mode.
Mode

Accessing Path

User EXEC

Primary mode once

Mode

Privileged

EXEC Mode

it is connected with

Prompt

T1600G-52TS>

disconnect the switch.

Use the enable command to

access Privileged EXEC mode.
Enter the disable or the exit
command to return to User

Use the enable

this mode from User

mode

Use the exit command to

the switch.

command to enter

Logout or Access the next

T1600G-52TS#

EXEC mode.

EXEC mode.

Enter configure command to
access Global Configuration

mode.

Use the exit or the end

command or press Ctrl+Z to

return to Privileged EXEC mode.

Global

Configuration
Mode

Use the configure

command to enter
this mode from

Use the interface

T1600G-52TS(config)#

gigabitEthernet port or

interface range

gigabitEthernet port-list

Privileged EXEC

command to access interface

mode.

Configuration mode.

Use the vlan vlan-list to access
VLAN Configuration mode.

Layer 2 Interface:
Use the interface
gigabitEthernet

Interface

Configuration
Mode

port, interface
port-channel

T1600G-52TS (config-if)#

port-channel-id or
interface range

gigabitEthernet

port-list command to

or
T1600G-52TS(config-if-range)#

Use the end command or press
Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged
EXEC mode.

Enter the exit or the # command
to return to Global Configuration
mode.
A port number must be specified
in the interface command.

enter this mode from
Global Configuration

mode.

12

Mode

Accessing Path

Prompt

Logout or Access the next
mode

Layer 3 Interface:

Use the no
switchport
command to enter
Routed Port mode
from Interface
Configuration mode.

Interface

Configuration
Mode

Use the interface
vlan vlan-id
command to enter
VLAN Interface
mode from Global
Configuration mode.

T1600G-52TS (config-if)#
or
T1600G-52TS(config-if-range)#

Use the switchport command to
switch to the Layer 2 interface
mode.

Use the end command or press
Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged
EXEC mode.

Enter the exit or the # command

to return to Global Configuration
mode.

Use the interface
loopback id

command to enter

Loopback Interface
mode from Global

Configuration mode.

VLAN

Configuration
Mode

1.
2.

Use the end command or press

Use the vlan vlan-list
command to enter
this mode from

Ctrl+Z to return to Privileged
T1600G-52TS (config-vlan)#

Global Configuration

EXEC mode.

Enter the exit command or the #
command to return to Global

mode.

configuration mode.

Note:

The user is automatically in User EXEC Mode after the connection between the PC and the

switch is established by a Telnet/SSH connection.

Each command mode has its own set of specific commands. To configure some

commands, you should access the corresponding command mode firstly.


Global Configuration Mode: In this mode, global commands are provided, such as the
Spanning Tree, Schedule Mode and so on.



Interface Configuration Mode: In this mode, users can configure one or several ports,

different ports corresponds to different commands

a). Interface gigabitEthernet: Configure parameters for an Ethernet port, such as
Duplex-mode, flow control status.

b). Interface range gigabitEthernet: Configure parameters for several Ethernet ports.

13

c). Interface link-aggregation: Configure parameters for a link-aggregation, such as
broadcast storm.

d). Interface range link-aggregation: Configure parameters for multi-trunks.
e). Interface vlan: Configure parameters for the vlan-port.


VLAN Configuration Mode: In this mode, users can create a VLAN and add a specified
port to the VLAN.

3. Some commands are global, that means they can be performed in all modes:


show: Display all information of switch, for example: statistic information, port

information, VLAN information.


history: Display the commands history..

1.3 Privilege Restrictions
This switch’s security is divided into four privilege levels: User level, Power User level, Operator
level and Admin level. You can define username and password pairs, and assign a specific
privilege level to each pair. Different privilege levels have access to specified commands,

which is illustrated in the Privilege Requirement in each command. For details about how to

configure usename and password pairs, please refer to user name (password) and user name
(secret).

Users can enter Privileged EXEC mode from User EXEC mode by using the enable command. In
default case, no password is needed. In Global Configuration Mode, you can configure

password for Admin level by enable password command. Once password is configured, you
are required to enter it to access Privileged EXEC mode.

1.4 Conventions
1.4.1 Format Conventions
The following conventions are used in this Guide:


Items in square brackets [ ] are optional



Items in braces { } are required



Alternative items are grouped in braces and separated by vertical bars. For example:
speed {10 | 100 | 1000 }



Bold indicates an unalterable keyword. For example: show logging

14



Normal Font indicates a constant (several options are enumerated and only one can be
selected). For example: mode {dynamic | static | permanent}



Italic Font indicates a variable (an actual value must be assigned). For example: bridge

aging-time aging-time

1.4.2 Special Characters
You should pay attentions to the description below if the variable is a character string:


These six characters ” < > , \ & cannot be input.



If a blank is contained in a character string, single or double quotation marks should be

used, for example ’hello world’, ”hello world”, and the words in the quotation marks will be
identified as a string. Otherwise, the words will be identified as several strings.

1.4.3 Parameter Format
Some parameters must be entered in special formats which are shown as follows:


MAC address must be enter in the format of xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.



One or several values can be typed for a port-list or a vlan-list using comma to separate.

Use a hyphen to designate a range of values, for instance, 1/0/1, 1/0/3-5, 1/0/7 indicates

choosing port 1/0/1, 1/0/3, 1/0/4, 1/0/5, 1/0/7.

15

Chapter 2
2.1

User Interface

enable
Description
The enable command is used to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User
EXEC Mode.

Syntax
enable

Command Mode
User EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
If you have set the password to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User
EXEC Mode:
T1600G-28TS>enable
Enter password:
T1600G-28TS#

2.2

service password-encryption
Description
The service password-encryption command is used to encrypt the

password when the password is defined or when the configuration is written,
using the symmetric encryption algorithm. Encryption prevents the password

from being readable in the configuration file. To disable the global encryption
function, please use no service password-encryption command.

Syntax
service password-encryption

no service password-encryption

16

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable the global encryption function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# service password-encryption

2.3

enable password
Description
The enable password command is used to set or change the password for
users to access Privileged EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode. To remove the

password, please use no enable password command. This command uses
the symmetric encryption.

Syntax
enable password { [ 0 ] password | 7 encrypted-password }

no enable password

Parameter
0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password
will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0.

password —— Super password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric

characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English

letters

(case

sensitive),

underlines

( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). By default, it is empty.

and

sixteen

special

characters

7 —— Indicates a symmetric encrypted password with fixed length will follow.

encrypted-password —— A symmetric encrypted password with fixed length,
which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. After the

encrypted password is configured, you should use the corresponding
unencrypted password if you re-enter this mode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

17

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

If the password you configured here is unencrypted and the global
encryption function is enabled in service password-encryption, the

password in the configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric
encrypted form.

Example
Set the super password as “admin” and unencrypted to access Privileged

EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode:

T1600G-28TS(config)#enable password 0 admin

2.4

enable secret
Description
The enable secret command is used to set a secret password, which is using

an MD5 encryption algorithm, for users to access Privileged EXEC Mode from
User EXEC Mode. To return to the default configuration, please use no enable
secret command. This command uses the MD5 encryption.

Syntax
enable secret { [ 0 ] password | 5 encrypted-password }

no enable secret

Parameter
0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password
will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0.

password —— Super password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric

characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English
letters

(case

sensitive),

underlines

and

sixteen

special

characters

( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). By default, it is empty. The password in the configuration file
will be displayed in the MD5 encrypted form.

5 —— Indicates an MD5 encrypted password with fixed length will follow.

encrypted-password —— An MD5 encrypted password with fixed length,
which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. After the

18

encrypted password is configured, you should use the corresponding
unencrypted password if you re-enter this mode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

If both the enable password and enable secret are defined, you must enter
the password set in enable secret.

Example
Set the secret password as “admin” and unencrypted to access Privileged
EXEC Mode from User EXEC Mode. The password will be displayed in the

encrypted form.

T1600G-28TS(config)#enable secret 0 admin

2.5

configure
Description
The configure command is used to access Global Configuration Mode from
Privileged EXEC Mode.

Syntax
configure

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Access Global Configuration Mode from Privileged EXEC Mode:
T1600G-28TS# configure
T1600G-28TS(config)#

19

2.6

exit
Description
The exit command is used to return to the previous Mode from the current
Mode.

Syntax
exit

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Return to Global Configuration Mode from Interface Configuration Mode, and
then return to Privileged EXEC Mode:
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# exit
T1600G-28TS(config)#exit
T1600G-28TS#

2.7

end
Description
The end command is used to return to Privileged EXEC Mode.

Syntax
end

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Return to Privileged EXEC Mode from Interface Configuration Mode:
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#end
T1600G-28TS#

20

2.8

clipaging
Description
The clipaging command is used to enable the pause function for the screen
display. If you want to display all the related information of the switch at once
when using the show command, please use no clipaging command.

Syntax
clipaging

no clipaging

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Disable the pause function for the screen display:
T1600G-28TS(config)#no clipaging

2.9

history
Description
The history command is used to show the latest 20 commands you entered

in the current mode since the switch is powered.

Syntax
history

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Show the commands you have entered in the current mode:
T1600G-28TS (config)# history
1 history
21

2.10

history clear
Description
The history clear command is used to clear the commands you have entered
in the current mode, therefore these commands will not be shown next time
you use the history command.

Syntax
history clear

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Clear the commands you have entered in the current mode:
T1600G-28TS(config)#history clear

22

Chapter 3

User Management Commands

User Management commands are used to manage the user’s logging information by Web,
Telnet or SSH, so as to protect the settings of the switch from being randomly changed.

3.1

user name (password)
Description
The user name command is used to add a new user or modify the existed

users’ information. To delete the existed users, please use no user name
command. This command uses the symmetric encryption.

Syntax
user name name [ privilege admin | operator | power_user | user ] password
{ [ 0 ] password | 7 encrypted-password }

no user name name

Parameter
name ——Type a name for users' login, which contains 16 characters at most,
composed of digits, English letters and under dashes only.

admin | operator | power_user | user —— Access level. “admin” means that

you can edit, modify and view all the settings of different functions. “operator”

means that you can edit, modify and view most of the settings of different
functions. “power-user” means that you can edit, modify and view some of

the settings of different functions. “user” means that you can only view some

of the settings of different functions without the right to edit or modify. It is
“admin” by default. For more details about privilege restrictions, please refer
to the Privilege Requirement part in each command.

0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password
will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0.

password —— Users’ login password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric

characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English
letters

(case

( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ).

sensitive),

underlines

and

sixteen

special

characters

7 —— Indicates a symmetric encrypted password with fixed length will follow.

encrypted-password —— A symmetric encrypted password with fixed length,
which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file. After the
23

encrypted password is configured, you should use the corresponding
unencrypted password if you re-enter this mode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

If the password you configured here is unencrypted and the global
encryption function is enabled in service password-encryption, the

password in the configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric
encrypted form.

Example
Add and enable a new admin user named “tplink”, of which the password is
“admin” and unencrypted:

T1600G-28TS(config)#user name tplink privilege admin password 0 admin

3.2

user name (secret)
Description
The user name command is used to add a new user or modify the existed

users’ information. To delete the existed users, please use no user name
command. This command uses the MD5 encryption.

Syntax
user name name [ privilege admin | operator | power_user | user ] secret { [ 0 ]

password | 5 encrypted-password }
no user name name

Parameter
name ——Type a name for users' login, which contains 16 characters at most,
composed of digits, English letters and under dashes only.

admin | operator | power_user | user —— Access level. “admin” means that

you can edit, modify and view all the settings of different functions. “operator”
means that you can edit, modify and view most of the the settings of different

functions. “power-user” means that you can edit, modify and view some of
24

the the settings of different functions. “user” means that you can only view

some of the the settings of different functions without the right to edit or
modify. It is “admin” by default.

0 —— Specify the encryption type. 0 indicates that an unencrypted password
will follow. By default, the encryption type is 0.

password ——Users’ login password, a string from 1 to 31 alphanumeric

characters or symbols. The password is case sensitive, allows digits, English
letters

(case

sensitive),

underlines

and

sixteen

special

characters

( !$%'()*,-./[]{|} ). The password will be saved to the configuration file using the
MD5 encrypted algorithm.

5 —— Indicates an MD5 encrypted password with fixed length will follow.

encrypted-password —— An MD5 encrypted password with fixed length,
which you can copy from another switch’s configuration file.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

If both the user name (password) and user name (secret) are defined, only
the latest configured password will take effect.

Example
Add and enable a new admin user named “tplink”, of which the password is
“admin”. The password will be displayed in the encrypted form.

T1600G-28TS(config)#user name tplink privilege admin secret 0 admin

3.3

show user account-list
Description
The show user account-list command is used to display the information of

the current users.

Syntax
show user account-list

Command Mode
25

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the information of the current users:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show user account-list

3.4

show user configuration
Description
The show user configuration command is used to display the security

configuration information of the users, including access-control, max-number

and the idle-timeout, etc.

Syntax
show user configuration

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the security configuration information of the users:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show user configuration

26

Chapter 4

System Configuration Commands

System Commands can be used to configure the System information and System IP, reboot
and reset the switch, upgrade the switch system and other operations.

4.1

system-time manual
Description

The system-time manual command is used to configure the system time

Syntax

manually.

system-time manual time

Parameter

time —— Set the date and time manually, MM/DD/YYYY-HH:MM:SS. The valid

value of the year ranges from 2000 to 2037.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the system mode as manual, and the time is 12/20/2010 17:30:35
T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time manual 12/20/2010-17:30:35

4.2

system-time ntp
Description

Syntax

The system-time ntp command is used to configure the time zone and the IP
address for the NTP Server. The switch will get UTC automatically if it has
connected to an NTP Server.
system-time ntp { timezone } { ntp-server } { backup-ntp-server }
{ fetching-rate }

Parameter

timezone —— Your local time-zone, and it ranges from UTC-12:00 to

UTC+13:00.

27

The detailed information that each time-zone means are displayed as follow:

UTC-12:00 —— TimeZone for International Date Line West.

UTC-11:00 —— TimeZone for Coordinated Universal Time-11.
UTC-10:00 —— TimeZone for Hawaii.

UTC-09:00 —— TimeZone for Alaska.

UTC-08:00 —— TimeZone for Pacific Time(US Canada).

UTC-07:00 —— TimeZone for Mountain Time(US Canada).
UTC-06:00 —— TimeZone for Central Time(US Canada).

UTC-05:00 —— TimeZone for Eastern Time(US Canada).
UTC-04:30 —— TimeZone for Caracas.

UTC-04:00 —— TimeZone for Atlantic Time(Canada).

UTC-03:30 —— TimeZone for Newfoundland.

UTC-03:00 —— TimeZone for Buenos Aires, Salvador, Brasilia.

UTC-02:00 —— TimeZone for Mid-Atlantic.

UTC-01:00 —— TimeZone for Azores, Cape Verde Is.
UTC

—— TimeZone for Dublin, Edinburgh, Lisbon, London.

UTC+01:00 —— TimeZone for Amsterdam, Berlin, Bern, Rome, Stockholm,
Vienna.
UTC+02:00 —— TimeZone for Cairo, Athens, Bucharest, Amman, Beirut,
Jerusalem.
UTC+03:00 —— TimeZone for Kuwait, Riyadh, Baghdad.
UTC+03:30 —— TimeZone for Tehran.

UTC+04:00 —— TimeZone for Moscow, St.Petersburg, Volgograd, Tbilisi,
Port Louis.
UTC+04:30 —— TimeZone for Kabul.

UTC+05:00 —— TimeZone for Islamabad, Karachi, Tashkent.

UTC+05:30 —— TimeZone for Chennai, Kolkata, Mumbai, New Delhi.
UTC+05:45 —— TimeZone for Kathmandu.

UTC+06:00 —— TimeZone for Dhaka,Astana, Ekaterinburg.
UTC+06:30 —— TimeZone for Yangon (Rangoon).

UTC+07:00 —— TimeZone for Novosibrisk, Bangkok, Hanoi, Jakarta.

UTC+08:00—— TimeZone for Beijing, Chongqing, Hong Kong, Urumqi,
Singapore.
UTC+09:00 —— TimeZone for Seoul, Irkutsk, Osaka, Sapporo, Tokyo.

UTC+09:30 —— TimeZone for Darwin, Adelaide.

UTC+10:00 —— TimeZone for Canberra, Melbourne, Sydney, Brisbane.

UTC+11:00 —— TimeZone for Solomon Is., New Caledonia, Vladivostok.
UTC+12:00 —— TimeZone for Fiji, Magadan, Auckland, Welington.
UTC+13:00 —— TimeZone for Nuku'alofa, Samoa.

ntp-server —— The IP address for the Primary NTP Server.
28

backup-ntp-server —— The IP address for the Secondary NTP Server.
fetching-rate —— Specify the rate fetching time from NTP server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the system time mode as NTP, the time zone is UTC-12:00, the

primary NTP server is 133.100.9.2 and the secondary NTP server is
139.78.100.163, the fetching-rate is 11 hours:

T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time ntp UTC-12:00 133.100.9.2
139.79.100.163 11

4.3

system-time dst predefined
Description

The system-time dst predefined command is used to select a daylight

saving time configuration from the predefined mode. The configuration can

be used recurrently. To disable DST function, please use no system-time dst

Syntax

command.

system-time dst predefined [ USA | Australia | Europe | New-Zealand ]
no system-time dst

Parameter

USA | Australia | Europe | New-Zealand —— The mode of daylight saving time.
There are 4 options which are USA, Australia, Europe and New-Zealand
respectively. The default value is Europe.

Following are the time ranges of each option:
USA —— Second Sunday in March, 02:00 ~ First Sunday in November, 02:00.
Australia —— First Sunday in October, 02:00 ~ First Sunday in April, 03:00.
Europe —— Last Sunday in March, 01:00 ~ Last Sunday in October, 01:00.

New Zealand —— Last Sunday in September, 02:00 ~ First Sunday in April,

03:00.

29

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the daylight saving time as USA standard:
T1600G-28TS(config)#system-time dst predefined USA

4.4

system-time dst date
Description
The system-time dst date command is used to configure the one-off

daylight saving time. The start date is in the current year by default. The time

range of the daylight saving time must shorter than one year, but you can

configure it spanning years. To disable DST function, please use no

Syntax

system-time dst command.

system-time dst date {smonth } {sday } {stime } {syear } {emonth } {eday }
{etime } {eyear }[offset ]

no system-time dst

Parameter

smonth ——The start month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values
showing as follows: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec.

sday —— The start day of the daylight saving time, ranging from 1 to 31. Here
you should show special attention to February and the differences between a
solar month and a lunar month.

stime —— The start moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM.
syear —— The start year of the daylight saving time.

emonth —— The end month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values
showing as follows: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec.

eday —— The end day of the daylight saving time, ranging from q to 31. Here

you should show special attention to February and the differences between a
solar month and a lunar month.

etime —— The end moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM.
eyear —— The end year of the daylight saving time.
30

offset —— The number of minutes to add during the daylight saving time. It is
60 minutes by default.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the daylight saving time from zero clock, Apr 1st to zero clock Oct
1st and the offset is 30 minutes in 2015:

T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time dst date Apr 1 00:00 2015 Oct 1 00:00
2015 30

4.5

system-time dst recurring
Description

The system-time dst recurring command is used to configure the recurring

daylight saving time. It can be configured spanning years. To disable DST

Syntax

function, please use no system-time dst command.

system-time dst recurring {sweek} {sday} {smonth} {stime} {eweek} {eday}
{emonth} {etime} [offset]
no system-time dst

Parameter

sweek——The start week of the daylight saving time. There are 5 values
showing as follows: first, second, third, fourth, last.

sday —— The start day of the daylight saving time. There are 7 values

showing as follows: Sun, Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat.

smonth —— The start month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values

showing as follows: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov, Dec.

stime —— The start moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM.

eweek ——The end week of the daylight saving time. There are 5 values
showing as follows: first, second, third, fourth, last.

eday —— The end day of the daylight saving time. There are 5 values
showing as follows: Sun, Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat.

31

emonth —— The end month of the daylight saving time. There are 12 values

showing as following: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug, Sep, Oct, Nov,
Dec.

etime —— The end moment of the daylight saving time, HH:MM.

offset —— The number of minutes to add during the daylight saving time. It is
60 minutes by default.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the daylight saving time from 2:00am, the first Sunday of May to
2:00am, the last Sunday of Oct and the offset is 45 minutes:

T1600G-28TS(config)# system-time dst recurring first Sun May 02:00 last
Sun Oct 02:00 45

4.6

hostname
Description

The hostname command is used to configure the system name. To clear the

Syntax

system name information, please use no hostname command.
hostname [ hostname ]
no hostname

Parameter

hostname —— System Name. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 32

characters. By default, it is the device name, for example “T1600G-28TS”.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the system name as TPLINK:
32

T1600G-28TS(config)# hostname TPLINK

4.7

location
Description

The location command is used to configure the system location. To clear the

Syntax

system location information, please use no location command.
location [ location ]
no location

Parameter

location —— Device Location. It consists of 32 characters at
most. It is “SHENZHEN” by default.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the system location as SHENZHEN:
T1600G-28TS(config)# location SHENZHEN

4.8

contact-info
Description

The contact-info command is used to configure the system contact

information. To clear the system contact information, please use no

Syntax

contact-info command.

contact-info [ contact_info ]
no contact-info

Parameter

contact_info —— Contact Information. It consists of 32 characters at most. It
is “www.tp-link.com” by default.

33

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the system contact information as www.tp-link.com:
T1600G-28TS(config)# contact-info www.tp-link.com

4.9

ip address
Description
This ip address command is used to configure the IP address and IP subnet
mask for the specified interface manually. The interface type includes: routed
port, port-channel interface, loopback interface and VLAN interface.

Syntax
ip address { ip-addr } { mask } [ secondary ]

no ip address [ ip-addr ] [ mask ]

Parameter
ip-addr —— The IP address of the Layer 3 interface.

mask —— The subnet mask of the Layer 3 interface.
secondary —— Specify the interface’s secondary IP address. If this
parameter is omitted here, the configured IP address is the interface’s
primary address.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the VLAN interface 2 with the primary IP address as 192.168.1.1/24
and secondary IP address as 192.168.2.1/24:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2
34

T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip address 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0

T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip address 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 secondary

4.10

ip address-alloc
Description
The IP address-alloc command is used to enable the DHCP Client function or

the BOOTP Protocol. When this function is enabled, the specified interface

will obtain IP from DHCP Server or BOOTP server. To disable the IP obtaining

function on the specified interface, please use the no ip address command.

This command applies to the routed port, the port-channel interface and the
VLAN interface.

Syntax
ip address-alloc { dhcp | bootp }
no ip address

Parameter
dhcp —— Specify the Layer 3 interface to obtain IP address from the DHCP

Server.

bootp —— Specify the Layer 3 interface to obtain IP address from the
BOOTP Server.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the DHCP Client function on the Lay 3 routed port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip address-alloc dhcp
Disable the IP address obtaining function on the VLAN interface 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no ip address
35

4.11

reset
Description

The reset command is used to reset the switch’s software. After resetting, all
configuration of the switch will restore to the factory defaults and your

Syntax

current settings will be lost.
reset

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Reset the software of the switch:
T1600G-28TS# reset

4.12

reboot
Description

The reboot command is used to reboot the Switch. To avoid damage, please

Syntax

don’t turn off the device while rebooting.
reboot

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Reboot the switch:
T1600G-28TS# reboot

36

4.13

reboot-schedule
Description
This reboot-schedule command is used to configure the switch to reboot at

a certain time point. To delete the reboot schedule settings, please use the
reboot-schedule cancel command.

Syntax
reboot-schedule at time [ date ] [ save_before_reboot ]

reboot-schedule in interval [ save_before_reboot ]
reboot-schedule cancel

Parameter
time —— Specify the time point for the switch to reboot, in the format of
hh:mm.

date —— Specify the date for the switch to reboot, in the format of

DD:MM:YYYY. The date should be within 30 days.

save_before_reboot —— Save the configuration file before the switch
reboots.

interval —— Specify a time period after which the switch reboots. It ranges
from 1 to 43200 minutes.

cancel —— Delete the reboot schedule settings.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

In the command reboot-schedule at time [ date ] [ save_before_reboot ], if

no date is specified and the time you set here is later than the time that this
command is executed, the switch will reboot later that day; otherwise the
switch will reboot at the time point the next day.

Example
Specify the switch to save the configuration files and reboot in 200 minutes,:
T1600G-28TS(config)# reboot-schedule in 200 save_before_reboot

37

4.14

copy running-config startup-config
Description

The copy running-config startup-config command is used to save the

Syntax

current settings.

copy running-config startup-config

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Save current settings:
T1600G-28TS# copy running-config startup-config

4.15

copy startup-config tftp
Description

The copy startup-config tftp command is used to backup the configuration

Syntax

file to TFTP server.

copy startup-config tftp ip-address ip-addr filename name

Parameter

ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are
supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be backup.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Backup the configuration files to TFTP server with the IP 192.168.0.148 and
name this file config.cfg:

38

T1600G-28TS# copy startup-config tftp ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename
config
Backup the configuration files to TFTP server with the IP fe80::1234 and name
this file config.cfg:

T1600G-28TS# copy startup-config tftp ip-address fe80::1234 filename
config

4.16

copy tftp startup-config
Description

The copy tftp startup-config command is used to download the

Syntax

configuration file to the switch from TFTP server.

copy tftp startup-config ip-address ip-addr filename name

Parameter

ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are
supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be
downloaded.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Download the configuration file named as config.cfg to the switch from TFTP

server with the IP 192.168.0.148:

T1600G-28TS# copy tftp startup-config ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename
config
Download the configuration file named as config.cfg to the switch from TFTP

server with the IP fe80::1234

T1600G-28TS# copy tftp startup-config ip-address fe80::1234 filename
config

39

4.17

copy backup-config tftp
Description

The copy backup-config tftp command is used to export the backup

Syntax

configuration file of the switch to TFTP server.

copy backup-config tftp ip-address ip-addr filename name

Parameter

ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are
supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be exported.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Export the backup configuration file of the switch to the TFTP server with the

IP 192.168.0.148 and name the file config.cfg:

T1600G-28TS# copy backup-config tftp ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename
config

4.18

copy backup-config startup-config
Description

The copy backup-config startup-config command is used to replace the

Syntax

startup configuration file using the backup configuration file.
copy backup-config startup-config

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

40

Example

Replace the startup configuration file using the backup configuration file.:
T1600G-28TS# copy backup-config startup-config

4.19

copy running-config backup-config
Description

The copy running-config backup-config tftp command is used to save the

Syntax

current running configuration as the backup configuration file.
copy running-config backup-config

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Save the current running configuration as the backup configuration file.
T1600G-28TS# copy running-config backup-config

4.20

copy tftp backup-config
Description

The copy tftp backup-config command is used to download the backup

Syntax

configuration file from a TFTP server.

Copy tftp backup-config ip-address ip-addr filename name

Parameter

ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are
supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

name —— Specify the name for the configuration file which would be
downloaded.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
41

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Download the configuration file named config.cfg from the TFTP server with
the IP 192.168.0.148:

T1600G-28TS# copy tftp backup-config ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename
config

4.21

boot application
Description

The boot application command is used to configure the image file as startup
image or backup image.

Syntax
boot application filename { image1 | image 2 } { startup | backup }
no boot application

Parameter
image1 | image2 —— Specify the image file to be configured. By default, the
image1.bin is the startup image and the image2.bin is the backup image.

startup | backup —— Specify the property of the image, either startup image

or backup image.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the image2.bin as the startup image:
T1600G-28TS(config)# boot application filename image2 startup

42

4.22

boot config
Description

The boot config command is used to configure the configuration file as
startup configuration or backup configuration.

Syntax
boot config filename { config1 | config 2 } { startup | backup }
no boot application

Parameter
config1 | config2 —— Specify the configuration file to be configured. By

default, the config1.cfg is the startup image and the config2.cfg is the backup
image.

startup | backup—— Specify the property of the configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the config2.cfg as the startup image:
T1600G-28TS(config)# boot config filename config2 startup

4.23

remove backup-image
Description
The remove backup-image command is used to delete the backup-image.

Syntax
remove backup-image

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.
43

Example
Delete the backup image file:
T1600G-28TS# remove backup-image

4.24

firmware upgrade
Description

The firmware upgrade command is used to upgrade the switch’s backup

iamge file via the TFTP server. The uploaded firmware file will take place of
the Backup Image, and user can chose whether to reboot the switch will the

Syntax

Backup Image.

firmware upgrade ip-address ip-addr filename name

Parameter

ip-addr —— IP Address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are
supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

name —— Specify the name for the firmware file.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Upgrade the switch’s backup iamge file with the file firmware.bin in the TFTP
server with the IP address 192.168.0.148, and reboot the switch with this
firmware:

T1600G-28TS# firmware upgrade ip-address 192.168.0.148 filename
firmware.bin
It will only upgrade the backup image. Continue? (Y/N):y
Operation OK!
Reboot with the backup image? (Y/N): y
Upgrade the switch’s backup iamge file with the file firmware.bin in the TFTP
server with the IP address fe80::1234, but do not reboot the switch:

44

T1600G-28TS#

firmware

upgrade

ip-address

fe80::1234

filename

firmware.bin
It will only upgrade the backup image. Continue? (Y/N):y
Operation OK!
Reboot with the backup image? (Y/N): n

4.25

ping
Description

The ping command is used to test the connectivity between the switch and

Syntax

one node of the network.

ping [ ip | ipv6 ] { ip_addr } [ -n count ] [ -l size ] [ -i interval ]

Parameter

ip —— The type of the IP address for ping test should be IPv4.

ipv6 —— The type of the IP address for ping test should be IPv6.

ip_addr —— The IP address of the destination node for ping test. If the

parameter ip/ipv6 is not selected, both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are
supported, for example 192.168.0.100 or fe80::1234.

-n count —— The amount of times to send test data during Ping testing. It

ranges from 1 to 10. By default, this value is 4.

-l size—— The size of the sending data during ping testing. It ranges from 1 to
1500 bytes. By default, this value is 64.

-i interval —— The interval to send ICMP request packets. It ranges from 100

to 1000 milliseconds. By default, this value is 1000.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

To test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the
IP 192.168.0.131, please specify the count (-l) as 512 bytes and count (-i) as

1000 milliseconds. If there is not any response after 8 times’ Ping test, the
connection between the switch and the network device is failed to establish:
45

T1600G-28TS# ping 192.168.0.131 –n 8 –l 512
To test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the
IP fe80::1234, please specify the count (-l) as 512 bytes and count (-i) as 1000

milliseconds. If there is not any response after 8 times’ Ping test, the
connection between the switch and the network device is failed to establish:
T1600G-28TS# ping fe80::1234 –n 8 –l 512

4.26

tracert
Description

The tracert command is used to test the connectivity of the gateways during

Syntax

its journey from the source to destination of the test data.

tracert [ ip | ipv6 ] ip_addr [ maxHops ]

Parameter

ip —— The type of the IP address for tracert test should be IPv4.
ipv6 —— The type of the IP address for tracert test should be IPv6.

ip_addr —— The IP address of the destination device. If the parameter ip/ipv6

is not selected, both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are supported, for example
192.168.0.100 or fe80::1234.

maxHops —— The maximum number of the route hops the test data can pass

though. It ranges from 1 to 30. By default, this value is 4.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the IP

192.168.0.131. If the destination device has not been found after 20

maxHops, the connection between the switch and the destination device is
failed to establish:

T1600G-28TS# tracert 192.168.0.131 20

46

Test the connectivity between the switch and the network device with the IP
fe80::1234. If the destination device has not been found after 20 maxHops,

the connection between the switch and the destination device is failed to
establish:

T1600G-28TS# tracert fe80::1234 20

4.27

show system-info
Description

The show system-info command is used to display System Description,

Device Name, Device Location, System Contact, Hardware Version, Firmware

Syntax

Version, System Time, Run Time and so on.
show system-info

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the system information:
T1600G-28TS# show system-info

4.28

show image-info
Description
The show image-info command is used to display the information of image

files in the system.

Syntax
show image-info

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.
47

Example
Display the system image files’ information:
T1600G-28TS# show image-info

4.29

show boot
Description
The show boot command is used to display the boot configuration of the
system.

Syntax
show boot

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the system boot configuration information:
T1600G-28TS# show boot

4.30

show running-config
Description

The show running-config command is used to display the current operating

Syntax

configuration of the system or of a specified port.

show running-config

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

48

Example

Display the system current operating configuration:
T1600G-28TS# show running-config

4.31

show startup-config
Description

The show startup-config command is used to display the current

configuration saved in the switch. These configuration settings will not be lost

Syntax

the next time you reboot the switch.
show startup-config

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the saved configuration:
T1600G-28TS# show startup-config

4.32

show system-time
Description

The show system-time command is used to display the time information of

Syntax

the switch.

show system-time

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the time information of the switch
T1600G-28TS# show system-time
49

4.33

show system-time dst
Description

The show system-time dst command is used to display the DST information

Syntax

of the switch.

show system-time dst

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the DST information of the switch
T1600G-28TS# show system-time dst

4.34

show system-time ntp
Description

The show system-time ntp command is used to display the NTP mode

Syntax

configuration information.
show system-time ntp

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the NTP mode configuration information of the switch:
T1600G-28TS# show system-time ntp

50

4.35

show cable-diagnostics interface
Description

The show cable-diagnostics interface command is used to display the cable
diagnostics of the connected Ethernet Port., which facilitates you to check

the connection status of the cable connected to the switch, locate and

Syntax

diagnose the trouble spot of the network.

show cable-diagnostics interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port

| ten-gigabitEthernet port }

Parameter

port —— The number of the port which is selected for Cable test.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Show the cable-diagnostics of port 3:
T1600G-28TS# show cable-diagnostics interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3

4.36

show cpu-utilization
Description
The show cpu-utilization command is used to display the system’s CPU
utilization in the last 5 seconds/1minute/5minutes.

Syntax
show cpu-utilization

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

51

Example
Display the CPU utilization information of the switch:
T1600G-28TS# show cpu-utilization

4.37

show memory-utilization
Description

The show memory-utilization command is used to display the current
system’s memory utilization in the last 5 seconds/1minute/5minutes.

Syntax
show memory-utilization

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the memory utilization information of the switch:
T1600G-28TS# show memory-utilization

52

Chapter 5

EEE Configuration Commands

EEE (Energy Efficient Ethernet) is used to save power consumption of the switch during periods
of low data activity. You can simply enable this feature on ports to allow power reduction.

5.1

eee
Description

The eee command is used to enable EEE on the port. To disable EEE on the

Syntax

port, please use no eee command.
eee
no eee

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable EEE on port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#eee

5.2

show interface eee
Description

The show interface eee command is used to display the EEE configuration

Syntax

on each port.

show interface eee [ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |

ten-gigabitEthernet port ]

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

53

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the EEE configuration of each port
T1600G-28TS# show interface eee

54

Chapter 6

SDM Template Commands

This chapter describes how to configure the Switch Database Management (SDM) templates to
allocate hardware resources on the switch for different uses.

6.1

sdm prefer
Description
The sdm prefer command is used to configure the SDM template. The SDM

template is used to allocate system resources to best support the features

being used in your application. To return to use the default template, please

use the sdm prefer default command. The template change will takes effect
after a reboot.

Syntax
sdm prefer { default | enterpriseV4 | enterpriseV6 }

Parameter

default —— Specify the SDM template used in the switch as “default”.
enterpriseV4 —— Specify the SDM template used in the switch as

“enterpriseV4”.

enterpriseV6 —— Specify the SDM template used in the switch as

“enterpriseV6”.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Specify the SDM template as enterpriseV4:
T1600G-28TS(config)# sdm prefer enterpriseV4

55

6.2

show sdm prefer
Description
The show sdm prefer command is used to display resource allocation of the
current SDM template in use, or the SDM templates that can be used.

Syntax
show sdm prefer { used | default | enterpriseV4 | enterpriseV6 }

Parameter

used —— Display the resource allocation of the template currently in use, and

the template that will become active after a reboot.

default —— Display the resource allocation of the default template.
enterpriseV4 —— Display the resource allocation of the enterpriseV4

template. enterpriseV6 —— Display the resource allocation of the

enterpriseV6 template.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the resource allocation of the template currently in use, and the
template that will become active after a reboot:

T1600G-28TS(config)#show sdm prefer used

56

Chapter 7

Time Range Commands

With this feature, you can configure a time range and bind it to a PoE port or an ACL rule.

7.1

time-range
Description

The time-range command is used to create time-range entry w for the switch

and enter Time-range Create Configuration Mode. After a time-range entry is

created, you need to specify the date and time. A time-range can implement
multiple time-ranges simultaneously as long as they do not conflict with each

other. To delete the corresponding time-range configuration, please use no

Syntax

time-range command.
time-range name

no time-range name

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Parameter

name —— The time-range name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create a time-range named “tRange1” for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# time-range tRange1

7.2

absolute
Description

The absolute command is used to create an absolute time-range for the

time-range of the switch. To delete the corresponding absolute time-range
configuration, please use no absolute command.

57

Syntax

absolute from start-date to end-date
no absolute [index ]

Parameter

start-date —— The start date in Absoluteness Mode, in the format of
MM/DD/YYYY.

end-date —— The end date in Absoluteness Mode, in the format of
MM/DD/YYYY.

Command Mode

Power Time-range Create Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create an absolute time-range for the switch and specify the date extending

from May 5th, 2017 through Oct. 5th, 2017:

T1600G-28TS(config)#time-range tRange1
T1600G-28TS(config-time-range)#absolute from 05/05/2017 to
10/05/2017

7.3

periodic
Description

The periodic command is used to create a periodic mode time-range for the

time-range of the switch. To delete the corresponding periodic mode

Syntax

time-range configuration, please use no periodic command.

periodic { [start start-time ] [ end end-time ] [day-of-the-week week-day ]

no periodic [ index ]

Parameter

start-time——Specify the start time in the format of HH:MM
end-time——Specify the end time in the format of HH:MM

week-day ——Specify the days of a week in the format of 1-3, 7. The

numbers 1-7 respectively represent Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday,
Thursday, Friday, Saturday and Sunday.
58

Command Mode

Power Time-range Create Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the time-range named “tRange2” as a periodic time-range and

specify the date and time as 8:30 to 12:00 on weekends:
T1600G-28TS(config)#time-range tRange2

T1600G-28TS(config -time-range)#periodic start 08:30 end 12:00
day-of-the-week 6-7

7.4

holiday (time-range mode)
Description

The holiday command is used to create holiday mode time-range for the

time-range of the switch. When the holiday which is excluded from

Syntax

time-range occurs, the switch will not supply power.
holiday { exclude | include }

Parameter

exclude ——The time range will not take effect on holiday.
include —— The time range will take effect on holiday.

Command Mode

Power Time-range Create Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create a time-range entry named “tRange3” and configure time-range to

exclude the holiday:

T1600G-28TS(config)#time-range tRange3
T1600G-28TS(config-time-range)#holiday exclude

59

7.5

holiday
Description

The holiday command is used to create holiday for the switch. To delete the

Syntax

corresponding holiday configuration, please use no holiday command.
holiday name start-date start-date end-date end-date
no holiday name

Parameter

name —— The holiday name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.

start-date —— The start date of the holiday, in the format of MM/DD, for
instance, 05/01.

end-date ——The end date of the holiday, in the format of MM/DD, for
instance, 05/01.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create a holiday named “holiday1” and configure the start date as October
1st and the end date as October 3rd:

T1600G-28TS(config)# holiday holiday1 start-date 10/01 end-date 10/03

7.6

show holiday
Description
Syntax

The show holiday command is used to display the defined holiday.
show holiday

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.
60

Example

Display the defined holiday:
T1600G-28TS# show holiday

7.7

show time-range
Description
Syntax

The show holiday command is used to display the defined holiday.
show time-range

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the defined holiday:
T1600G-28TS# show holiday

61

Chapter 8

Port Configuration Commands

Ethernet Configuration Commands can be used to configure the Bandwidth Control,
Negotiation Mode and Storm Control for Ethernet ports.

8.1

interface gigabitEthernet
Description
The interface gigabitEthernet command is used to enter the Interface

gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode and configure the corresponding Gigabit
Ethernet port.

Syntax
interface gigabitEthernet port

Parameter
port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
To enter the Interface gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode and configure port
2:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2

8.2

interface range gigabitEthernet
Description
The interface range gigabitEthernet command is used to enter the interface

range gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode and configure multiple Gigabit
Ethernet ports at the same time.

62

Syntax
interface range gigabitEthernet port-list

Parameter
port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

User Guidelines

Command in the Interface Range gigabitEthernet Mode is executed
independently on all ports in the range. It does not affect the execution on the
other ports at all if the command results in an error on one port.

Example
To enter the Interface range gigabitEthernet Configuration Mode, and

configure ports 1, 2, 3, 6, 7 and 9 at the same time by adding them to one
port-list:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet
1/0/1-3,1/0/6-7,1/0/9

8.3

description
Description
The description command is used to add a description to the Ethernet port.
To clear the description of the corresponding port, please use no
description command.

Syntax
description string
no description

Parameter
string —— Content of a port description, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.

63

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Add a description Port_5 to port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# description Port_5

8.4

shutdown
Description
The shutdown command is used to disable an Ethernet port. To enable this

Syntax

port again, please use no shutdown command.
shutdown
no shutdown

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Disable port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# shutdown

64

8.5

flow-control
Description

The flow-control command is used to enable the flow-control function for a

port. To disable the flow-control function for this corresponding port, please
use no flow-control command. With the flow-control function enabled, the

Ingress Rate and Egress Rate can be synchronized to avoid packet loss in the

Syntax

network.

flow-control
no flow-control

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the flow-control function for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# flow-control

8.6

duplex
Description

The duplex command is used to configure the Duplex Mode for an Ethernet
port. To return to the default configuration, please use no duplex command.

Syntax
duplex { auto | full | half }
no duplex

Parameter
auto | full | half —— The duplex mode of the Ethernet port. There are three

options: auto-negotiation mode, full-duplex mode and half-duplex mode. By

default the Gigabit Ethernet port is auto-negotiation mode.

65

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the Duplex Mode as full-duplex for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# duplex full

8.7

jumbo-size
Description
Syntax

The jumbo-size command is used to specify the size of jumbo frames.
jumbo-size size

Parameter

size —— The value of jumbo frames. It ranges from 1518 to 9216 bytes, and

the default is 1518 bytes.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Globally configure the size of jumbo frames as 9216:
T1600G-28TS(config)# jumbo-size 9216

8.8

speed
Description

The speed command is used to configure the Speed Mode for an Ethernet
port. To return to the default configuration, please use no speed command.

66

Syntax

speed { 10 | 100 | 1000 | auto }
no speed

Parameter

10 | 100 | 1000 | auto —— The speed mode of the Ethernet port. There are

four options: 10Mbps, 100Mbps, 1000Mbps and Auto negotiation mode
(default).

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the Speed Mode as 100Mbps for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# speed 100

8.9

clear counters
Description

The clear counters command is used to clear the statistics information of all

Syntax

the Ethernet ports and port channels.
clear counters

clear counters interface [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel

port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

67

Example

Clear the statistic information of all ports and port channels:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear counters

8.10

show interface status
Description

The show interface status command is used to display the connection

Syntax

status of the Ethernet port/port channel.
show

interface
port-channel-id ]

status

[

gigabitEthernet

port

]

[

port-channel

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel..

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the connection status of all ports and port channels:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface status
Display the connection status of port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface status gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

8.11

show interface counters
Description

The show interface counters command is used to display the statistics

Syntax

information of all ports/port channels.

show interface counters [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel
port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.
68

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the statistics information of all Ethernet ports and port channels:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface counters
Display the statistics information of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface counters gigabitEthernet 1/0/2

8.12

show interface configuration
Description

The show interface configuration command is used to display the

configurations of all ports and port channels, including Port-status, Flow

Syntax

Control, Negotiation Mode and Port-description.

show interface configuration [ gigabitEthernet port ] [ port-channel
port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the configurations of all Ethernet ports and port channels:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface configuration
Display the configurations of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface configuration gigabitEthernet 1/0/2

69

Chapter 9

Port Isolation Commands

Port Isolation provides a method of restricting traffic flow to improve the network security by
forbidding the port to forward packets to the ports that are not on its forwarding port list.

9.1

port isolation
Description

The port isolation command is used to configure the forward port/port
channel list of a port/port channel, so that this port/port channel can only

communicate with the ports/port channels on its list. To delete the

Syntax

corresponding configuration, please use no port isolation command.

port isolation { [ fa-forward-list fa-forward-list ] [ gi-forward-list

gi-forward-list ] [ po-forward-list po-forward-list ] [ te-forward-list
te-forward-list ] }

no port isolation

Parameter

fa-forward-list / gi-forward-list / te-forward-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.
po-forward-list —— The list of port channels.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Set port 1, 2, 4 and port channel 2 to the forward list of port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#

port

isolation

gi-forward-list

1/0/1-2,1/0/4

po-forward-list 2
Set all Ethernet ports and port channels to forward list of port 1/0/2, namely
restore to the default setting:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2

70

T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no port isolation

9.2

show port isolation interface
Description

The show port isolation interface command is used to display the forward

Syntax

port list of a port/port channel.

show port isolation interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The number of Ethernet port you want to show its forward port list,

in the format of 1/0/2.

port-channel-id —— The ID of port channel you want to show its forward port
list, ranging from 1 to 6.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the forward-list of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS# show port isolation interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
Display the forward-list of all Ethernet ports and port channels:
T1600G-28TS# show port isolation interface

71

Chapter 10 Loopback Detection Commands
With loopback detection feature enabled, the switch can detect loops using loopback

detection packets. When a loop is detected, the switch will display an alert or further block the
corresponding port according to the configuration.

10.1

loopback-detection (global)
Description

The loopback-detection command is used to enable the loopback detection

Syntax

function globally. To disable it, please use no loopback detection command.
loopback-detection
no loopback-detection

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the loopback detection function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# loopback-detection

10.2

loopback-detection interval
Description

The loopback-detection interval command is used to define the interval of

sending loopback detection packets from switch ports to network, aiming at

Syntax

detecting network loops periodically.

loopback-detection interval interval-time

Parameter

interval-time —— The interval of sending loopback detection packets. It
ranges from 1 to 1000 seconds. By default, this value is 30.
72

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the interval-time as 50 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# loopback-detection interval 50

10.3

loopback-detection recovery-time
Description

The loopback-detection recovery-time command is used to configure the

time after which the blocked port would automatically recover to normal

Syntax

status.

loopback-detection recovery-time recovery-time

Parameter

recovery-time —— The time after which the blocked port would automatically
recover to normal status, and the loopback detection would restart. It ranges
from 2 to 1000000 seconds. By default, this value is 90.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the recovery-time as 70 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# loopback-detection recovery-time 70

73

10.4

loopback-detection (interface)
Description

The loopback-detection command is used to enable the loopback

detection function of the specified port. To disable it, please use no

Syntax

loopback-detection command.
loopback-detection
no loopback-detection

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet | interface range
gigabitEthernet | interface port-channel | interface range port-channel )

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the loopback detection function of ports 1-3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3
T1600G-28TS(Config-if-range)# loopback-detection

10.5

loopback-detection config process-mode
Description

The loopback-detection config process-mode command is used to

configure the process-mode for the ports by which the switch copes with the

detected loops. You also need to configure the recovery mode to remove the
block status of the port or VLAN when the process-mode is Port Based or

Syntax

VLAN Based.

loopback-detection config process-mode { alert | port-based | vlan-based }

recovery-mode { auto | manual }

Parameter

alert —— When a loop is detected, the switch will send a trap message and

generate an entry on the log file. It is the default setting.

port-based —— When a loop is detected, the switch will send a trap message

and generate an entry on the log file. In addition, the switch will block the port
74

on which the loop is detected and no packets can pass through the port.

vlan-based —— When a loop is detected, the switch will send a trap message

and generate an entry on the log file. In addition, the switch will block the

VLAN in which the loop is detected and only the packets of the blocked VLAN
cannot pass through the port.

auto —— Block status can be automatically removed after recovery time.
manual —— Block status can only be removed manually.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet | interface range
gigabitEthernet | interface port-channel | interface range port-channel )

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the loopback detection process-mode as port-based, and
configure the recovery mode as manual for port 2:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# loopback-detection config process-mode
port-based recovery-mode manual

10.6

loopback-detection recover
Description

The loopback-detection recover command is used to remove the block

Syntax

status of selected ports, recovering the blocked ports to normal status,
loopback-detection recover

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet | interface range
gigabitEthernet | interface port-channel | interface range port-channel )

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Recover the blocked port 1/0/2 to normal status:
75

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# loopback-detection recover

10.7

show loopback-detection global
Description

The show loopback-detection global command is used to display the global

configuration of loopback detection function such as loopback detection
global status, loopback detection interval and loopback detection recovery

Syntax

time.

show loopback-detection global

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the global configuration of loopback detection function:
T1600G-28TS# show loopback-detection global

10.8

show loopback-detection interface
Description

The show loopback-detection interface command is used to display the

configuration of loopback detection function and the status of the specified

Syntax

Ethernet port.

show loopback-detection interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel

lagid ] [ detail ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

lagid —— The number of LAG, ranging from 1 to 14.
detail —— Displays the loop status and block status of the VLAN which the

specified port belongs to.

76

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the configuration of loopback detection function and the status of all
ports:

T1600G-28TS# show loopback-detection interface
Display the configuration of loopback detection function and the status of
port 5:

T1600G-28TS# show loopback-detection interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5

77

Chapter 11 Etherchannel Commands
Etherchannel Commands are used to configure LAG and LACP function.
LAG (Link Aggregation Group) is to combine a number of ports together to make a single
high-bandwidth data path, which can highly extend the bandwidth. The bandwidth of the LAG is
the sum of bandwidth of its member port.

LACP (Link Aggregation Control Protocol) is defined in IEEE802.3ad and enables the dynamic

link aggregation and disaggregation by exchanging LACP packets with its partner. The switch
can dynamically group similarly configured ports into a single logical link, which will highly

extend the bandwidth and flexibly balance the load.

11.1

channel-group
Description
The channel-group command is used to add a port to the EtherChannel

Group and configure its mode. To delete the port from the EtherChannel
Group, please use no channel-group command.

Syntax
channel-group num mode { on | active | passive }
no channel-group

Parameter
num —— The number of the EtherChannel Group, ranging from 1 to 14.
on —— Enable the static LAG.
active —— Enable the active LACP mode.
passive —— Enable the passive LACP mode.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

78

Example
Add ports 2-4 to EtherChannel Group 1 and enable the static LAG:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-4
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)# channel-group 1 mode on

11.2

port-channel load-balance
Description
The port-channel load-balance command is used to configure the

Aggregate Arithmetic for LAG. To return to the default configurations, please
use no port-channel load-balance command.

Syntax
port-channel load-balance { src-mac | dst-mac | src-dst-mac | src-ip | dst-ip |

src-dst-ip }

no port-channel load-balance

Parameter
src-mac —— The source MAC address. When this option is selected, the
Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source MAC address of the
packets.

dst-mac —— The destination MAC address. When this option is selected, the

Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the destination MAC address of the
packets.

src-dst-mac —— The source and destination MAC address. When this option
is selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source and
destination MAC addresses of the packets. The Aggregate Arithmetic for
LAG is “src-dst-mac” by default.

src-ip —— The source IP address. When this option is selected, the
Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source IP address of the packets.

dst-ip —— The destination IP address. When this option is selected, the
Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the destination IP address of the
packets.

src-dst-ip —— The source and destination IP address. When this option is
selected, the Aggregate Arithmetic will be based on the source and
destination IP addresses of the packets.

79

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the Aggregate Arithmetic for LAG as “src-dst-ip”:
T1600G-28TS(config)# port-channel load-balance src-dst-ip

11.3

lacp system-priority
Description

The lacp system-priority command is used to configure the LACP system

priority globally. To return to the default configurations, please use no lacp

system-priority command.

Syntax
lacp system-priority pri
no lacp system-priority

Parameter
pri —— The system priority, ranging from 0 to 65535. It is 32768 by default.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the LACP system priority as 1024 globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# lacp system-priority 1024

80

11.4

lacp port-priority
Description
The lacp port-priority command is used to configure the LACP port priority
for specified ports. To return to the default configurations, please use no lacp
port-priority command.

Syntax
lacp port-priority pri

no lacp port-priority

Parameter
pri —— The port priority, ranging from 0 to 65535. It is 32768 by default.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the LACP port priority as 1024 for ports 1-3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)# lacp port-priority 1024
Configure the LACP port priority as 2048 for port 4:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lacp port-priority 2048

11.5

show etherchannel
Description
The show etherchannel command is used to display the EtherChannel

Syntax

information.

show etherchannel [ channel-group-num ] { detail | summary }
81

Parameter
channel-group-num —— The EtherChannel Group number, ranging from 1 to
14. By default, it is empty, and will display the information of all EtherChannel

Groups.

detail —— The detailed information of EtherChannel.
summary —— The EtherChannel information in summary.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the detailed information of EtherChannel Group 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show etherchannel 1 detail

11.6

show etherchannel load-balance
Description
The show etherchannel load-balance command is used to display the
Aggregate Arithmetic of LAG.

Syntax
show etherchannel load-balance

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the Aggregate Arithmetic of LAG:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show etherchannel load-balance

82

11.7

show lacp
Description
The show lacp command is used to display the LACP information for a

specified EtherChannel Group.

Syntax
show lacp [ channel-group-num ] { internal | neighbor }

Parameter

channel-group-num —— The EtherChannel Group number, ranging from 1 to
14. By default, it is empty, and will display the information of all LACP groups.
internal —— The internal LACP information.
neighbor —— The neighbor LACP information.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the internal LACP information of EtherChannel Group 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show lacp 1 internal

11.8

show lacp sys-id
Description
The show lacp sys-id command is used to display the LACP system priority

globally.

Syntax
show lacp sys-id

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.
83

Example
Display the LACP system priority:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show lacp sys-id

84

Chapter 12 MAC Address Commands
MAC Address configuration can improve the network security by configuring the Port Security
and maintaining the address information by managing the Address Table.

12.1

mac address-table static
Description
The mac address-table static command is used to add the static MAC

address entry. To remove the corresponding entry, please use no mac

address-table static command. The static address can be added or removed
manually, independent of the aging time. In the stable networks, the static

MAC address entries can facilitate the switch to reduce broadcast packets

Syntax

and enhance the efficiency of packets forwarding remarkably.

mac address-table static mac-addr vid vid interface { fastEthernet port |
gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port }

no mac address-table static mac-addr vid vid interface { fastEthernet port |
gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port }

Parameter

mac-addr ——The MAC address of the entry you desire to add.

vid —— The VLAN ID number of your desired entry. It ranges from 1 to 4094.
port —— The Ethernet port number of your desired entry.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Add a static Mac address entry to bind the MAC address 00:02:58:4f:6c:23,
VLAN1 and port 1 together:

T1600G-28TS(config)# mac address-table static 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 vid 1
interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

85

12.2

mac address-table aging-time
Description

The mac address-table aging-time command is used to configure aging

time for the dynamic address. To return to the default configuration, please

Syntax

use no mac address-table aging-time command.
mac address-table aging-time aging-time

no mac address-table aging-time

Parameter

aging-time —— The aging time for the dynamic address. The value of it can

be 0 or ranges from 10 to 630 seconds. When 0 is entered, the Auto Aging
function is disabled. It is 300 by default.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the aging time as 500 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# mac address-table aging-time 500

12.3

mac address-table filtering
Description

The mac address-table filtering command is used to add the filtering
address entry. To delete the corresponding entry, please use no mac

address-table filtering command. The filtering address function is to forbid
the undesired package to be forwarded. The filtering address can be added

Syntax

or removed manually, independent of the aging time.
mac address-table filtering mac-addr vid vid

no mac address-table filtering {[ mac-addr ] [ vid vid ]}

Parameter

mac-addr —— The MAC address to be filtered.
86

vid —— The corresponding VLAN ID of the MAC address. It ranges from 1 to
4094.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Add a filtering address entry of which VLAN ID is 1 and MAC address is
00:1e:4b:04:01:5d:

T1600G-28TS(config)# mac address-table filtering 00:1e:4b:04:01:5d vid 1

12.4

mac address-table max-mac-count
Description

The mac address-table max-mac-count command is used to configure the

Port Security. To return to the default configurations, please use no mac

address-table max-mac-count command. Port Security is to protect the

switch from the malicious MAC address attack by limiting the maximum

number of the MAC addresses that can be learned on the port. The port with
Port Security feature enabled will learned the MAC address dynamically.

When the learned MAC address number reaches the maximum, the port will
stop learning. Therefore, the other devices with the MAC address unlearned

Syntax

cannot access to the network via this port.

mac address-table max-mac-count { [ max-number num ] [ mode { dynamic |

static | permanent } ] [ status { forward | drop | disable } ]
[ exceed-max-learned enable | disable ] }

no mac address-table max-mac-count [ max-number | mode | status ]

Parameter

num —— The maximum number of MAC addresses that can be learned on
the port. It ranges from 0 to 64. By default this value is 64.

dynamic | static | permanent —— Learn mode for MAC addresses. There are
three modes, including Dynamic mode, Static mode and Permanent mode.

When Dynamic mode is selected, the learned MAC address will be deleted

automatically after the aging time. When Static mode is selected, the learned
87

MAC address will be out of the influence of the aging time and can only be

deleted manually. The learned entries will be cleared after the switch is
rebooted. When permanent mode is selected, the learned MAC address will

be out of the influence of the aging time and can only be deleted manually too.
However, the learned entries will be saved even the switch is rebooted.

status —— Select the action to be taken when the number of the MAC

addresses reaches the maximum learning number on the port. By default this
function is disabled.

•
forward: The packets will be forward but not be learned when learned
MAC number exceeds the maximum MAC address number on this port.
•
drop: The packets will be dropped when learned MAC number exceeds
the maximum MAC address number on this port.
•

disable: The MAC address threshold on this port is disabled.

new-mac-learned enable | disable —— Enable/Disable the new-mac-learned
notification on this port. With this feature enabled, a SNMP notification is
generated and sent to the network management system (NMS) when the port
learns a new MAC address.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable Port Security function for port 1/0/1, select Static mode as the learn

mode, and specify the maximum number of MAC addresses that can be
learned on this port as 30. When the number of MAC address entries reaches
30 on this port, new entry will be dropped:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# mac address-table max-mac-count max-number
30 mode static status drop

88

12.5

show mac address-table
Description

The show mac address-table command is used to display the information of

Syntax

all address entries.

show mac address-table { dynamic | static | filtering }

Parameter

dynamic | static | filtering —— The type of your desired entry. By default all

the entries are displayed.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the information of all address entries:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table

12.6

clear mac address-table
Description

The show mac address-table command is used to clear the specified

Syntax

address entries.

clear mac address-table { dynamic | static | filtering }

Parameter

dynamic | static | filtering —— The type of your desired entry.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Clear the information of all static address entries:
89

T1600G-28TS(config)# clear mac address-table static

12.7

show mac address-table aging-time
Description

The show mac address-table aging-time command is used to display the

Syntax

Aging Time of the MAC address.

show mac address-table aging-time

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the Aging Time of the MAC address:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table aging-time

12.8

show mac address-table max-mac-count
Description

The show mac address-table max-mac-count interface gigabitEthernet

command is used to display the security configuration of all ports or the

Syntax

specified port.

show mac address-table max-mac-count { all | interface gigabitEthernet

port }

Parameter

all —— Displays the security information of all the Ethernet ports.

port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

90

Example

Display the security configuration of all ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table max-mac-count all
Display the security configuration of port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table max-mac-count interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

12.9

show mac address-table interface
Description

The show mac address-table interface command is used to display the

Syntax

address configuration of the specified port/port channel.

show mac address-table interface { gigabitEthernet port | port-channel

port-channel-id }

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the address configuration of port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/1

12.10 show mac address-table count
Description

The show mac address-table count command is used to display the total

Syntax

amount of MAC address table.

show mac address-table count [ vlan vlan-id ]
91

Parameter
vlan-id —— Specify the VLAN which the MAC entries belong to.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the total MAC entry information in different VLANs:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table count

12.11 show mac address-table address
Description

The show mac address-table address command is used to display the

Syntax

information of the specified MAC address.

show mac address-table address mac-addr [ interface { gigabitEthernet

port | port-channel port-channel-id } | vid vlan-id ]

Parameter

mac-addr ——The specified MAC address.
port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

vlan-id —— Specify the VLAN which the entry belongs to.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the information of the MAC address 00:00:00:00:23:00 in VLAN 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show mac address-table address 00:00:00:00:23:00
vid 1

92

12.12 show mac address-table vlan
Description

The show mac address-table vlan command is used to display the MAC

Syntax

address configuration of the specified vlan.
show mac address-table vlan vid

Parameter

vid ——The specified VLAN id.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the MAC address configuration of vlan 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show mac address-table vlan 1

93

Chapter 13 IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Commands
VLAN (Virtual Local Area Network) technology is developed for the switch to divide the LAN
into multiple logical LANs flexibly. Hosts in the same VLAN can communicate with each other,

regardless of their physical locations. VLAN can enhance performance by conserving
bandwidth, and improve security by limiting traffic to specific domains.

13.1

vlan
Description
The vlan command is used to create IEEE 802.1Q VLAN and enter VLAN
Configuration Mode. To delete the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN, please use no vlan
command.

Syntax

vlan vlan-list

no vlan vlan-list

Parameter

vlan-list —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID list, ranging from 2 to 4094, in the

format of 2-3, 5. It is multi-optional.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create VLAN 2-10 and VLAN 100:
T1600G-28TS(config)# vlan 2-10,100
Delete VLAN 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no vlan 2

94

13.2

name
Description
The name command is used to assign a description to a VLAN. To clear the
description, please use no name command.

Syntax

name descript
no name

Parameter

descript ——String to describe the VLAN, which contains 16 characters at
most.

Command Mode
VLAN Configuration Mode(VLAN)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the name of VLAN 2 as “group1”:
T1600G-28TS(config)# vlan 2
T1600G-28TS(config-vlan)# name group1

13.3

switchport general allowed vlan
Description
The switchport general allowed vlan command is used to add the desired

port to IEEE 802.1Q VLAN, or to remove a port from the corresponding VLAN.

Syntax
switchport general allowed vlan vlan-list { tagged | untagged }
no switchport general allowed vlan vlan-list

Parameter
vlan-list —— VLAN ID list, ranging from 2 to 4094, in the format of 2-3, 5. It is

multi-optional.

95

tagged | untagged —— egress-rule.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/4 whose link type is “general” to VLAN 2
and its egress-rule as “tagged”:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#switchport mode general
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#switchport general allowed vlan 2 tagged

13.4

switchport pvid
Description
The switchport pvid command is used to configure the PVID for the switch
ports.

Syntax

switchport pvid vlan-id

Parameter

vlan-id —— VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the PVID of port 1/0/2 as 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
96

T1600G-28TS(config-if)# switchport pvid 2

13.5

switchport check ingress
Description
The switchport check ingress command is used to enable the Ingress
Checking function for the switch ports. With this function enabled, the port
will accept the packet of which the VLAN ID is in the port's VLAN list and
discard others. With this function disabled, the port will forward the packet
directly. To disable this function, please use no switchport check ingress
command.

Syntax
switchport check ingress

no switchport check ingress

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable Ingress Checking on the port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# switchport check ingress

13.6

switchport acceptable frame
Description
The switchport acceptable frame command is used to specify the

acceptable frame type for the switch ports and the ports will perform this

operation before Ingress Checking. To restore to the default setting, please
use no switchport acceptable frame command.

Syntax
switchport acceptable frame { all | tagged }
97

no switchport acceptable frame

Parameter
all | tagged —— the acceptable frame type.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the acceptable frame type of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/4 as “tagged”:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#switchport acceptable frame general

13.7

show vlan summary
Description
The show vlan summary command is used to display the summarized
information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN.

Syntax
show vlan summary

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the summarized information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show vlan summary

98

13.8

show vlan brief
Description
The show vlan brief command is used to display the brief information of IEEE
802.1Q VLAN.

Syntax
show vlan brief

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the brief information of IEEE 802.1Q VLAN:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show vlan brief

13.9

show vlan
Description
The show vlan command is used to display the information of IEEE 802.1Q
VLAN.

Syntax

show vlan [ id vlan-id ]

Parameter

vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094. It is

multi-optional. Using the show vlan command without parameter displays the
detailed information of all VLANs.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

99

Example
Display the information of vlan 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show vlan id 5

13.10 show interface switchport
Description
The show interface switchport command is used to display the IEEE 802.1Q
VLAN configuration information of the specified port/port channel.

Syntax

show interface switchport [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the VLAN configuration information of all ports and port channels:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show interface switchport

100

Chapter 14 MAC-based VLAN Commands
MAC VLAN (Virtual Local Area Network) is the way to classify the VLANs based on MAC
Address. A MAC address is relative to a single VLAN ID. The untagged packets and the
priority-tagged packets coming from the MAC address will be tagged with this VLAN ID.

14.1

mac-vlan mac-address
Description
The mac-vlan mac-address command is used to create a MAC-based VLAN

entry. To delete a MAC-based VLAN entry, please use the no mac-vlan

mac-address command.

Syntax
mac-vlan mac-address mac-addr vlan vlan-id [description descript]

no mac-vlan mac-address mac-addr

Parameter
mac-addr —— MAC address, in the format of XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX.

vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094.

descript —— Give a description to the MAC address for identification, which

contains 8 characters at most.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create VLAN 2 with the MAC address 00:11:11:01:01:12 and the name “TP”:
T1600G-28TS(config)#mac-vlan mac-address 00:11:11:01:01:12 vlan 2
description TP

101

14.2

mac-vlan
Description
The mac-vlan command is used to enable a port for the MAC-based VLAN

feature. Only the port is enabled can the configured MAC-based VLAN take

effect. To disable the MAC-based VLAN function, please use no mac-vlan
command. All the ports are disabled by default.

Syntax
mac-vlan
no mac-vlan

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/3 for the MAC-based VLAN feature:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mac-vlan

14.3

show mac-vlan
Description
The show mac-vlan command is used to display the information of the

MAC-based VLAN entry. MAC address and VLAN ID can be used to filter the
displayed information.

Syntax
show mac-vlan { all | mac-address mac-addr | vlan vlan-id }

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

102

Privilege Requirement
None.

Parameter
mac-addr —— MAC address, in the format of XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX.

vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1 to 4094.

Example
Display the information of all the MAC-based VLAN entry:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show mac-vlan all

14.4

show mac-vlan interface
Description
The show mac-vlan interface command is used to display the port state of

MAC-based VLAN.

Syntax
show mac-vlan interface

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the enable state of all the ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show mac-vlan interface

103

Chapter 15 Protocol-based VLAN Commands
Protocol VLAN (Virtual Local Area Network) is the way to classify VLANs based on Protocols. A

Protocol is relative to a single VLAN ID. The untagged packets and the priority-tagged packets
matching the protocol template will be tagged with this VLAN ID.

15.1

protocol-vlan template
Description
The protocol-vlan template command is used to create Protocol-based

VLAN template. To delete Protocol-based VLAN template, please use no

protocol-vlan template command.

Syntax
protocol-vlan template name protocol-name frame { ether_2 ether-type

type | snap ether-type type | llc dsap dsap_type ssap ssap_type }
no protocol-vlan template template-idx

Parameter
protocol-name —— Give a name for the Protocol-based VLAN Template ,
which contains 8 characters at most.

ether_2 ether-type type —— Specify the Ethernet type.

snap ether-type type —— Specify the Ethernet type.

llc dsap dsap_type ssap ssap_type —— Specify the DSAP type and the
SSAP type.

template-idx —— The number of the Protocol-based VLAN Template. You

can get the template corresponding to the number by the show

protocol-vlan template command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

104

Example
Create a Protocol-based VLAN template named “TP” whose Ethernet
protocol type is 0x2024:

T1600G-28TS(config)#protocol-vlan template name TP frame ether_2
ether-type 2024

15.2

protocol-vlan vlan
Description
The protocol-vlan vlan command is used to create a Protocol-based VLAN
entry. To delete a Protocol-based VLAN entry, please use no protocol-vlan

vlan command.

Syntax
protocol-vlan vlan vlan-id priority priority template template-idx
no protocol-vlan vlan group-idx

Parameter
vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 1-4094.

priority—— Specify the 802.1p priority for the packets that belong to the

protocol VLAN, ranging from 0-7. The switch will determine the forwarding

sequence according this value. The packets with larger value of 802.1p
priority have the higher priority.

template-idx ——The number of the Protocol-based VLAN Template. You can

get the template corresponding to the number by the show protocol-vlan
template command.

group-idx ——The number of the Protocol-based VLAN entry. You can get
the Protocol-based VLAN entry corresponding to the number by the show

protocol-vlan vlan command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

105

Example
Create Protocol-based VLAN 2 and bind it with Protocol-based VLAN Template
3:

T1600G-28TS(config)#protocol-vlan vlan 2 template 3

15.3

protocol-vlan group
Description
The protocol-vlan command is used to add the port to a specified protocol

group. To remove the port from this protocol group, please use no
protocol-vlan group command.

Syntax
protocol-vlan group index

no protocol-vlan group index

Parameter
index —— Specify the protocol group ID.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Add Gigabit Ethernet port 20 to protocol group 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#protocol-vlan group 1

15.4

show protocol-vlan template
Description
The show protocol-vlan template command is used to display the

information of the Protocol-based VLAN templates.
106

Syntax
show protocol-vlan template

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the information of the Protocol-based VLAN templates:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show protocol-vlan template

15.5

show protocol-vlan vlan
Description
The show protocol-vlan vlan command is used to display the information

about Protocol-based VLAN entry.

Syntax
show protocol-vlan vlan

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display information of the Protocol-based VLAN entry:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show protocol-vlan vlan

107

Chapter 16 GVRP Commands
GVRP (GARP VLAN registration protocol) is an implementation of GARP (generic attribute

registration protocol). GVRP allows the switch to automatically add or remove the VLANs via
the dynamic VLAN registration information and propagate the local VLAN registration
information to other switches, without having to individually configure each VLAN.

16.1

gvrp
Description
The gvrp command is used to enable the GVRP function globally. To disable
the GVRP function, please use no gvrp command.

Syntax
gvrp
no gvrp

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the GVRP function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#gvrp

16.2

gvrp (interface)
Description
The gvrp command is used to enable the GVRP function for the desired port.

To disable it, please use no gvrp command. The GVRP feature can only be
enabled for the trunk-type ports.

Syntax
gvrp
108

no gvrp

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the GVRP function for Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-6:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-6
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#gvrp

16.3

gvrp registration
Description
The gvrp registration command is used to configure the GVRP registration
type for the desired port. To restore to the default value, please use no gvrp
registration command.

Syntax
gvrp registration { normal | fixed | forbidden }
no gvrp registration

Parameter
normal | fixed | forbidden —— Registration mode. By default, the registration
mode is “normal”.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

109

Example
Configure the GVRP registration mode as “fixed” for Gigabit Ethernet ports
1/0/2-6:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-6
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#gvrp registration fixed

16.4

gvrp timer
Description
The gvrp timer command is used to set a GVRP timer for the desired port. To
restore to the default setting of a GARP timer, please use no gvrp timer
command.

Syntax
gvrp timer { leaveall | join | leave } value
no gvrp timer [leaveall | join | leave]

Parameter
leaveall | join | leave —— They are the three timers: leave All, join and leave.

Once the LeaveAll Timer is set, the port with GVRP enabled can send a
LeaveAll message after the timer times out, so that other GARP ports can
re-register all the attribute information. After that, the LeaveAll timer will start

to begin a new cycle. To guarantee the transmission of the Join messages, a

GARP port sends each Join message two times. The Join Timer is used to

define the interval between the two sending operations of each Join
message. Once the Leave Timer is set, the GARP port receiving a Leave

message will start its Leave timer, and deregister the attribute information if it
does not receive a Join message again before the timer times out.

value ——The value of the timer. The LeaveAll Timer ranges from 1000 to

30000 centiseconds and the default value is 1000 centiseconds. The Join

Timer ranges from 20 to 1000 centiseconds and the default value is 20
centiseconds. The Leave Timer ranges from 60 to 3000 centiseconds and
the default value is 60 centiseconds.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

110

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the GARP leaveall timer of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/6 as 2000
centiseconds and restore the join timer of it to the default value:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/6
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#gvrp timer leaveall 2000
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#no gvrp timer join

16.5

show gvrp interface
Description
The show gvrp interface command is used to display the GVRP
configuration information of a specified Ethernet port or of all Ethernet ports.

Syntax
show gvrp

interface [fastEthernet port

| gigabitEthernet port |

ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the GVRP configuration information of Gigabit Ethernet port 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show gvrp interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
Display the GVRP configuration information of all Ethernet ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show gvrp interface

111

16.6

show gvrp global
Description
The show gvrp global command is used to display the global GVRP status.

Syntax
show gvrp global

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the global GVRP status:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show gvrp global

112

Chapter 17 IGMP Snooping Commands
IGMP Snooping (Internet Group Management Protocol Snooping) is a multicast control

mechanism running on Layer 2 switch. It can effectively prevent multicast groups being
broadcasted in the network.

17.1

ip igmp snooping (global)
Description

The ip igmp snooping command is used to configure IGMP Snooping

globally. To disable the IGMP Snooping function, please use no ip igmp

Syntax

snooping command.
ip igmp snooping

no ip igmp snooping

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable IGMP Snooping function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping

17.2

ip igmp snooping version
Description

The ip igmp snooping version command is used to configure IGMP version

globally. To return to the default configuration, please use no ip igmp

Syntax

snooping version command.

ip igmp snooping version {v1 | v2 | v3 }
no ip igmp snooping version

113

Parameter

v1 | v2 | v3—— Specify the IGMP version. By default, it is IGMP v3.

v1: The switch works as an IGMPv1 Snooping switch. It can only process
IGMPv1 messages from the host. Report messages of other versions are
ignored.

v2: The switch works as an IGMPv2 Snooping switch. It can process both
IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 messages from the host. IGMPv3 messages are ignored.

v3: The switch works as an IGMPv3 Snooping switch. It can process IGMPv1,
IGMPv2 and IGMPv3 messages from the host.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the IGMP version as v2:
T1600G-28TS (config)# ip igmp snooping version v2

17.3

ip igmp snooping drop-unknown
Description

Syntax

The ip igmp snooping drop-unknown command is used to configure the way
how the switch processes multicast streams that are sent to unknown
multicast groups as Discard. By default, it is Forward. To return to the default
configuration, please use no ip igmp snooping drop-unknown command.
ip igmp snooping drop-unknown
no ip igmp snooping drop-unknown

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the operation to process unknown multicast as discard:
114

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping drop-unknown

17.4

ip igmp snooping header-validation
Description

The ip igmp snooping header-validation command is used to enable IGMP
Header Validation globally. To disable the IGMP Header Validation function,
please use no ip igmp snooping header-validation command.

Syntax

Generally, for IGMP packets, the TTL value should be 1, ToS field should be
0xC0, and Router Alert option should be 0x94040000. The fields to be
validated depend on the IGMP version being used. IGMPv1 only checks the
TTL field. IGMPv2 checks the TTL field and the Router Alert option. IGMPv3
checks TTL field, ToS field and Router Alert option. Packets that fail the
validation process will be dropped.
ip igmp snooping header-validation
no ip igmp snooping header-validation

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable IGMP Header Validation:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping header-validation

17.5

ip igmp snooping vlan-config
Description

The ip igmp snooping vlan-config command is used to enable VLAN IGMP

Snooping function or to modify IGMP Snooping parameters. To disable the

VLAN IGMP Snooping function, please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config

command. To restore the default values, please use no ip igmp snooping

Syntax

vlan-config with specified parameters.

ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime router-time | mtime

member-time | ltime leave-time ]
115

no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime | mtime | ltime ]

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

router-time —— The Router Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the switch

does not receive IGMP query message from the router port, it will consider

this port is not a router port any more. Valid values are from 60 to 600 in
seconds, and the default value is 300 seconds.

member-time —— The Member Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the

switch does not receive IGMP report message from the member port, it will

consider this port is not a member port any more. Valid values are from 60 to
600 in seconds, and the default value is 260 seconds.

leave-time —— The Leave Time. Valid values are from 1 to 30 in seconds, and

the default value is 1 second. When the switch receives a leave message

from a port to leave a multicast group, it will wait for a Leave Time before

removing the port from the multicast group. During the period, if the switch
receives any report messages from the port, the port will not be removed
from the multicast group. Exceptions are as follows:


If the member port ages out before the Leave Time ends and no report
messages are received, the port will be removed from the multicast
group once its Member Port Aging Time ends.



The Leave Time mechanism will not take effect when Fast Leave takes
effect.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the IGMP Snooping function and modify Router Port Aging Time as
300 seconds, Member Port Aging Time as 200 seconds for VLAN 1-3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 rtime 300
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 mtime 200

116

17.6

ip igmp snooping vlan-config
(immediate-leave)
Description

This command is used to enable the Fast Leave feature for specific VLANs.
To disable Fast Leave on the VLANs, please use no ip igmp snooping

vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave command. This function is disabled

Syntax

by default.

ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave

no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the Fast Leave for VLAN 1-3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3 immediate-leave

17.7

ip igmp snooping vlan-config
(report-suppression)
Description

This command is used to enable the IGMP Report Suppression function for
specific VLANs. When enabled, the switch will only forward the first IGMP
report message for each multicast group to the IGMP querier and suppress

subsequent IGMP report messages for the same multicast group during one

query interval. This feature prevents duplicate report messages from being
sent to the IGMP querier. To disable the IGMP report suppression function

and forward all the IGMP reports to the Layer 3 device in specific VLANs,
117

please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression

Syntax

command. This function is disabled by default.

ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression

no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the IGMP Report Suppression for VLAN 1-3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-3
report-suppression

17.8

ip igmp snooping vlan-config
(router-ports-forbidden)
Description

This command is used to forbid the specified ports as being router ports in
the specified VLAN(s). To delete the forbidden router ports, please use no ip

Syntax

igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd command.

ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface

[ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list ]

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

118

port-list —— Forbid the specified ports as being router ports. Packets sent
from multicast routers to these ports will be discarded.

port-channel-list —— Forbid the specified port-channels as being router

ports. Packets sent from multicast routers to these port-channels will be
discarded.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Forbid the Ethernet ports 1/0/1-3 as being router ports in VLAN 1 :
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1
router-ports-forbidd interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3

17.9

ip igmp snooping vlan-config (rport interface)
Description

This command is used to specify the static router ports for specific VLANs.
To delete the static router ports, please use no ip igmp snooping

Syntax

vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface command.

ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface { gigabitEthernet

port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

no

ip

igmp

snooping

vlan-config

vlan-id-list

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

Parameter

rport

interface

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

port-channel-list—— The ID of the port channels.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
119

Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Set the router port as 1/0/1 for VLAN 1-2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 1-2 rport interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

17.10 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (static)
Description

This command is used to configure interfaces to statically join a multicast
group. To remove interfaces from a static multicast group, please use no ip

Syntax

igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list staticcommand.
ip

igmp

no

ip

snooping

vlan-config

vlan-id-list

static

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }
igmp

snooping

vlan-config

ip

interface

vlan-id-list static ip interface

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

ip ——Specify the IP address of the multicast group that the hosts want to
join.

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

port-channel-list —— The ID of the port channels.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure port ports 1/0/1-3 in VLAN 2 to statically join multicast group
225.0.0.1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 2 static 225.0.0.1
interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3
120

17.11 ip igmp snooping vlan-config (querier)
Description

This command is used to enable the IGMP Snooping Querier feature for

specific VLANs. To disable the IGMP Snooping Querier feature on the VLANs,
please use no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command

without any parameters. To restore the default values, please use no ip igmp
snooping

Syntax

parameters.

vlan-config

vlan-id-list

querier

command

with

specified

ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time

response-time | query-interval interval | general-query source-ip ip-addr |

last-member-query-count count | last-member-query-interval interval ]

no ip igmp snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time |
query-interval | general-query source-ip | last-member-query-count ]

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

response-time—— The host’s maximum response time to general query

messages. Valid values are from 1 to 25 seconds, and the default value is 10

seconds.

query-interval interval—— The interval between general query messages

sent by the switch. Valid values are from 10 to 300 seconds, and the default
value is 60 seconds.

ip-addr—— The source IP address of the general query messages sent by
the switch. It should be a unicast address. By default, it is 0.0.0.0.

count —— The number of group-specific queries to be sent. With IGMP

Snooping Querier enabled, when the switch receives an IGMP leave message,
it obtains the address of the multicast group that the host wants to leave from

the message. Then the switch sends out group-specific queries to this

multicast group through the port receiving the leave message. If specified
count of group-specific queries are sent and no report message is received,

the switch will delete the multicast address from the multicast forwarding
table. Valid values are from 1 to 5, and the default value is 2.

last-member-query-interval interval —— The interval between groupspecific queries.. Valid values are from 1 to 5 seconds, and the default value
is 1 second.

121

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the IGMP Snooping Querier for VLAN 3, and configure the query
interval as 100 seconds:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 3 querier
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp snooping vlan-config 3 querier query
interval 100

17.12 ip igmp snooping (interface)
Description

The ip igmp snooping command is used to enable the IGMP Snooping

function for the desired port. To disable the IGMP Snooping function, please

Syntax

use no ip igmp snooping command.
ip igmp snooping
no ip igmp snooping

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable IGMP Snooping function of port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip igmp snooping

122

17.13 ip igmp snooping max-groups
Description

The ip igmp snooping max-groups command is used to configure the

maximum number of groups that a port can join in. The ip igmp snooping

max-groups action is used to configure the action that the port takes when it

receives an IGMP report message and the maximum number of entries is in

the forwarding table. To remove the maximum group limitation and return to
the default of no limitation on the specified port, please use the no ip igmp

snooping max-groups command. To return to the default action of dropping
the report, please use the no ip igmp snooping max-groups action

Syntax

command. These commands only apply to the dynamic multicast groups.
ip igmp snooping max-groups maxgroup
ip igmp snooping max-groups action { drop | replace }
no ip igmp snooping max-groups
no ip igmp snooping max-groups action

Parameter

maxgroup —— Specify the maximum numbers of groups that the port can
join. It ranges from 0 to 1000 and the default value is 1000.

drop —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port joins
has exceeded the max-group, the port will not join any new multicast group.

replace —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port

joins has exceeded the max-group, the newly joined multicast group will

replace an existing multicast group with the lowest multicast group address.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the maximum numbers of groups that ports 1/0/2-5 can join as 10,

and configure the throttling action as replace:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5

123

T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip igmp snooping max-groups 10
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip igmp snooping max-groups action
replace

17.14 ip igmp snooping immediate-leave
Description

The ip igmp snooping immediate-leave command is used to configure the

Fast Leave function for port. To disable the Fast Leave function, please use

Syntax

no ip igmp snooping immediate-leave command.
ip igmp snooping immediate-leave
no ip igmp snooping immediate-leave

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the Fast Leave function for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip igmp snooping immediate-leave

17.15 ip igmp profile
Description
The ip igmp profile command is used to create the configuration profile. To
delete the corresponding profile, please use no ip igmp profile command.

Syntax
ip igmp profile id

no ip igmp profile id

124

Parameter
id —— Specify the id of the configuration profile, ranging from 1 to 999.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the profile 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1

17.16 deny
Description
The deny command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as deny.

Syntax
deny

Command Mode
Profile Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as deny:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1

T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#deny

17.17 permit
Description
The permit command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as
permit.

125

Syntax
permit

Command Mode
Profile Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as permit:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1

T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#permit

17.18 range
Description
The range command is used to configure the range of the profile’s filtering

multicast address. To delete the corresponding filtering multicast address,

please use no range command. A profile contains 16 filtering IP-range entries

at most.

Syntax
range start-ip end-ip

no range start-ip end-ip

Parameter
start-ip —— The start filtering multicast IP address.
end-ip —— The end filtering multicast IP address.

Command Mode
Profile Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

126

Example
Configure one of the filter multicast address entry as range 225.1.1.1 to
226.3.2.1 in profile 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip igmp profile 1

T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#range 225.1.1.1 226.3.2.1

17.19 ip igmp filter
Description

Syntax

The ip igmp filter command is used to bind the specified profile to the
interface. To delete the binding, please use no ip igmp filter command.
ip igmp filter profile-id
no ip igmp filter

Parameter

profile-id —— Specify the profile ID, ranging from 1 to 999.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Bind profile 1 to interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip igmp filter 1

17.20 clear ip igmp snooping statistics
Description

Syntax

The clear ip igmp snooping statistics command is used to clear the
statistics of the IGMP packets.
clear ip igmp snooping statistics

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
127

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Clear the statistics of the IGMP packets:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ip igmp snooping statistics

17.21 show ip igmp snooping
Description

The show ip igmp snooping command is used to display the global

Syntax

configuration of IGMP snooping.
show ip igmp snooping

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the global configuration of IGMP:
T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping

17.22 show ip igmp snooping interface
Description

The show ip igmp snooping interface command is used to display the port

configuration of IGMP snooping. If no interface is specified, it displays all

Syntax

interfaces’ IGMP snooping configurations.

show ip igmp snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet [port-list ] |

port-channel [ port-channel-list ] ] { basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat }

Parameter

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

Port-channel-list —— The list of port channels.

128

basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat —— The related configuration

information selected to display.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the IGMP baisic configuration configuration of all ports and port
channels:

T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping interface basic-config
Display the IGMP basic configuration of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
basic-config
Display the IGMP packet statistics of ports 1/0/1-4:
T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-4
packet-stat

17.23 show ip igmp snooping vlan
Description

The show ip igmp snooping vlan command is used to display the VLAN

Syntax

configuration of IGMP snooping.

show ip igmp snooping vlan [ vlan-id ]

Parameter

vlan-id ——The VLAN ID selected to display.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the IGMP snooping configuration information of VLAN 2:
T1600G-28TS# show ip igmp snooping vlan 2
129

17.24 show ip igmp snooping groups
Description

The show ip igmp snooping groups command is used to display the
information of all IGMP snooping groups. It can be extended to some other

commands to display the dynamic and static multicast information of a

Syntax

selected VLAN.

show ip igmp snooping groups [ vlan { vlan-id } ] [ multicast_addr | count |

dynamic | dynamic count | static | static count ]

Parameter

vlan-id ——The VLAN ID selected to display the information of all multicast
items.

multicast_addr —— IP address of the multicast group.
count—— The numbers of all multicast groups.
dynamic—— Display dynamic multicast groups.
dynamic count—— The numbers of all dynamic multicast groups.
static—— Display static multicast groups.
static count—— The numbers of all static multicast groups.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the information of all IGMP snooping groups:
T1600G-28TS#show ip igmp snooping groups
Display all the multicast entries in VLAN 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5
Display the count of multicast entries in VLAN 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 count
Display the dynamic multicast groups of VLAN 5
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 dynamic
Display the static multicast groups of VLAN 5
130

T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 static
Display the count of dynamic multicast entries of VLAN 5
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 dynamic
count
Display the count of static multicast entries of VLAN 5
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip igmp snooping groups vlan 5 static count

17.25 show ip igmp profile
Description
The show ip igmp profile command is used to display the configuration

information of all the profiles or a specific profile.

Syntax
show ip igmp profile [ id ]

Parameter
id —— Specify the ID of the profile, ranging from 1 to 999.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration information of all profiles:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip igmp profile

131

Chapter 18 MLD Snooping Commands
MLD Snooping (Multicast Listener Discovery Snooping) is a multicast control mechanism

running on Layer 2 switch. It can effectively prevent multicast groups being broadcasted in the
IPv6 network.

18.1

ipv6 mld snooping (global)
Description

Syntax

The ipv6 mld snooping command is used to enable MLD Snooping function
globally. If this function is disabled, all related MLD Snooping function would
not work. To disable this function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping
command.
ipv6 mld snooping

no ipv6 mld snooping

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable MLD Snooping:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping

18.2

ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown
Description

Syntax

The ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown command is used to enable the
unknown multicast packets filter function. To disable this function, please use
no ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown command. By default, it is disabled.
ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown

no ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

132

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable unknown multicast filter function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping drop-unknown

18.3

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config
Description

The ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config command is used to enable VLAN MLD

Snooping function or to modify MLD Snooping parameters. To disable the
VLAN MLD Snooping function, please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config

Syntax

command.

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime router-time | mtime

member-time | ltime leave-time ]

no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list [ rtime | mtime | ltime ]

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

router-time —— The Router Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the switch

does not receive any MLD query messages from the router port, it will

consider this port is not a router port any more. Valid values are from 60 to
600 in seconds, and the default value is 300 seconds.

member-time —— The Member Port Aging Time. Within this time, if the

switch does not receive any MLD report messages from the member port, it
will consider this port is not a member port any more. Valid values are from 60
to 600 in seconds, and the default value is 260 seconds.

leave-time —— The Leave Time. Valid values are from 1 to 30 in seconds, and

the default value is 1 second. When the switch receives a done message from

a port to leave a multicast group, it will wait for a Leave Time before removing

the port from the multicast group. During the period, if the switch receives
any report messages from the port, the port will not be removed from the
multicast group. Exceptions are as follows:


If the member port ages out before the Leave Time ends and no report

messages are received, the port will be removed from the multicast
group once its Member Port Aging Time ends.
133



The Leave Time mechanism will not take effect when Fast Leave takes
effect.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the MLD Snooping function and modify Router Port Time as 300
seconds, Member Port Time as 200 seconds for VLAN 1-3:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3 rtime 300
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3 mtime 200

18.4

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config
(immediate-leave)
Description

This command is used to enable the Fast Leave feature for specific VLANs.
To disable Fast Leave on the VLANs, please use no ipv6 mld snooping

vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave command. This function is disabled

Syntax

by default.

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave

no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list immediate-leave

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the Fast Leave for VLAN 1-3:

134

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3
immediate-leave

18.5

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config
(report-suppression)
Description

This command is used to enable the MLD Report Suppression function for
specific VLANs. When enabled, the switch will only forward the first MLD

report message for each multicast group to the MLD querier and suppress

subsequent MLD report messages for the same multicast group during one
query interval. This feature prevents duplicate report messages from being
sent to the MLD querier. To disable the MLD report suppression function and

forward all the MLD reports to the Layer 3 device in specific VLANs, please
use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression

Syntax

command. This function is disabled by default.

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression

no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list report-suppression

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the MLD Report Suppression for VLAN 1-3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-3
report-suppression

135

18.6

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config
(router-ports-forbidden)
Description

This command is used to forbid the specified ports as being router ports in

the specified VLAN(s). To delete the forbidden router ports, please use no

Syntax

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd command.

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd interface

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list router-ports-forbidd
interface [ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list ]

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

port-list —— Forbid the specified ports as being router ports. Packets sent
from multicast routers to these ports will be discarded.

port-channel-list —— Forbid the specified port-channels as being router

ports. Packets sent from multicast routers to these port-channels will be
discarded.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Forbid the Ethernet ports 1/0/1-3 as being router ports in VLAN 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1
router-ports-forbidd interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3

136

18.7

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (rport
interface)
Description

This command is used to specify the static router ports for specific VLANs.

To delete the static router ports, please use no ipv6 mld snooping

Syntax

vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface command.

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list rport interface { gigabitEthernet

port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

no

ipv6

mld

snooping

vlan-config

vlan-id-list

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

rport

interface

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

port-channel-list—— The ID of the port channels.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Set the router port as 1/0/1 for VLAN 1-2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 1-2 rport interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

18.8

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (static)
Description

This command is used to configure interfaces to statically join a multicast

group. To remove interfaces from a static multicast group, please use no
ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list staticcommand.

137

Syntax

ipv6

mld

snooping

vlan-config

vlan-id-list

static

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

ip

interface

no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list static ip interface

{ gigabitEthernet port-list | port-channel port-channel-list }

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

ip ——Specify the IP address of the multicast group that the hosts want to
join.

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

port-channel-list —— The ID of the port channels.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure port ports 1/0/1-3 in VLAN 2 to statically join multicast group
225.0.0.1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 2 static 225.0.0.1
interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-3

18.9

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config (querier)
Description

This command is used to enable the MLD Snooping Querier feature for

specific VLANs. To disable the MLD Snooping Querier feature on the VLANs,
please use no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command

without any parameters. To restore the default values, please use no ipv6
mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier command with specified
parameters.

138

Syntax

ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time

response-time | query-interval interval | general-query source-ip ip-addr |

last-listener-query-count count | last-listener-query-interval interval ]

no ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config vlan-id-list querier [ max-response-time |
query-interval | general-query source-ip | last-listener-query-count |

last-listener-query-interval ]

Parameter

vlan-id-list —— The ID list of the VLAN desired to modify configuration,
ranging from 1 to 4094, in the format of 1-3, 5.

response-time—— The host’s maximum response time to general query

messages. Valid values are from 1 to 25 seconds, and the default value is 10
seconds.

query-interval interval—— The interval between general query messages

sent by the switch. Valid values are from 10 to 300 seconds, and the default
value is 60 seconds.

ip-addr—— The source IP address of the general query messages sent by
the switch. It should be a unicast address. By default, it is fe80::2ff:ffff:fe00:1.

count —— The number of group-specific queries to be sent. With MLD

Snooping Querier enabled, when the switch receives an MLD done message,
it obtains the address of the multicast group that the host wants to leave from

the message. Then the switch sends out group-specific queries to this

multicast group through the port receiving the done message. If specified

count of group-specific queries are sent and no report message is received,

the switch will delete the multicast address from the multicast forwarding
table. Valid values are from 1 to 5, and the default value is 2.

last-member-query-interval interval —— The interval between groupspecific queries. Valid values are from 1 to 5 seconds, and the default value is
1 second.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

139

Example

Enable the MLD Snooping Querier for VLAN 3, and configure the query
interval as 100 seconds:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 3 querier
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld snooping vlan-config 3 querier query
interval 100

18.10 ipv6 mld snooping (interface)
Description

Syntax

The ipv6 mld snooping command is used to enable MLD Snooping function
on the desired port. To disable this function, please use no ipv6 mld
snooping command.
ipv6 mld snooping

no ipv6 mld snooping

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable MLD Snooping on port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 mld snooping

18.11 ipv6 mld snooping max-groups
Description

The ipv6 mld snooping max-groups command is used to configure the

maximum number of groups that a port can join in. The ipv6 mld snooping

max-groups action is used to configure the action that the port takes when it

receives an MLD report message and the maximum number of entries is in

the forwarding table. To remove the maximum group limitation and return to
the default of no limitation on the specified port, please use the no ipv6 mld
140

snooping max-groups command. To return to the default action of dropping
the report, please use the no ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action

Syntax

command. These commands only apply to the dynamic multicast groups.
ipv6 mld snooping max-groups maxgroup

ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action { drop | replace }
no ipv6 mld snooping max-groups
no ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action

Parameter

maxgroup —— Specify the maximum numbers of groups that the port can
join. It ranges from 0 to 1000 and the default value is 1000.

drop —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port joins
has exceeded the max-group, the port will not join any new multicast group.

replace —— When the number of the dynamic multicast groups that a port

joins has exceeded the max-group, the newly joined multicast group will

replace an existing multicast group with the lowest multicast group address.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Specify the maximum numbers of groups that ports 1/0/2-5 can join as 10,
and configure the throttling action as replace:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 mld snooping max-groups 10
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 mld snooping max-groups action
replace

18.12 ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave
Description

The ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave command is used to configure the

Fast Leave function for port. To disable the Fast Leave function, please use
no ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave command.
141

Syntax

ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave
no ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the Fast Leave function for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 mld snooping immediate-leave

18.13 ipv6 mld profile
Description
The ipv6 mld profile command is used to create the configuration profile. To
delete the corresponding profile, please use no ipv6 mld profile command.

Syntax
ipv6 mld profile id

no ipv6 mld profile id

Parameter
id —— Specify the id of the configuration profile, ranging from 1 to 999.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Create the profile 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1

142

18.14 deny
Description
The deny command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as deny.

Syntax
deny

Command Mode
Profile Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as deny:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1

T1600G-28TS(config-MLD-profile)#deny

18.15 permit
Description
The permit command is used to configure the filtering mode of profile as
permit.

Syntax
permit

Command Mode
Profile Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the filtering mode of profile 1 as permit:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1

T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#permit

143

18.16 range
Description
The range command is used to configure the range of the profile’s filtering
multicast address. To delete the corresponding filtering multicast address,

please use no range command. A profile contains 16 filtering IP-range entries

at most.

Syntax
range start-ip end-ip

no range start-ip end-ip

Parameter
start-ip —— Start IPv6 multicast address of the filter entry..
end-ip —— End IPv6 multicast address of the filter entry.

Command Mode
Profile Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure one of the filter multicast address entry as range ff80::1234 to
ff80::1235 in profile 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 mld profile 1

T1600G-28TS(config-igmp-profile)#range ff80::1234 ff80::1235

18.17 ipv6 mld filter
Description

Syntax

The ipv6 mld filter command is used to bind the specified profile to the
interface. To delete the binding, please use no ipv6 mld filter command.
ipv6 mld filter profile-id

no ipv6 mld filter

Parameter

profile-id —— Specify the profile ID, ranging from 1 to 999.

144

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Bind profile 1 to interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 mld filter 1

18.18 clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics
Description

Syntax

The clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics command is used to clear the
statistics of the MLD packets.
clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Clear the statistics of the MLD packets:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ipv6 mld snooping statistics

18.19 show ipv6 mld snooping
Description

Syntax

The show ipv6 mld snooping command is used to display the global
configuration of MLD Snooping.
show ipv6 mld snooping

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
145

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the global configuration of MLD Snooping:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld snooping

18.20 show ipv6 mld snooping interface
Description

The show ipv6 mld snooping interface command is used to display the port

Syntax

configuration of MLD snooping.

show ipv6 mld snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet [ port | port-list ] ]
{ basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat }

show ipv6 mld snooping interface [ port-channel [ port-channel-list ] ]
{ basic-config | max-groups }

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.
basic-config | max-groups | packet-stat —— The related configuration

information selected to display.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the MLD baisic configuration configuration of all ports and port
channels:

T1600G-28TS# show ipv6 mld snooping interface basic-config
Display the MLD basic configuration of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS# show ipv6 mld snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
basic-config

146

Display the MLD packet statistics of ports 1/0/1-4:
T1600G-28TS# show ipv6 mld snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1-4
packet-stat

18.21 show ipv6 mld snooping vlan
Description

Syntax

The show ipv6 mld snooping vlan command is used to display VLAN
information of MLD Snooping.
show ipv6 mld snooping vlan [ vlan-id ]

Parameter

vlan-id —— The VLAN ID selected to display, ranging from 1 to 4094.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display all of the VLAN information:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld snooping vlan

18.22 show ipv6 mld snooping groups
Description

Syntax

The show ipv6 mld snooping groups command is used to display multicast
groups.
show ipv6 mld snooping groups [ vlan { vlan-id } ] [ ipv6_multicast_addr |
count | dynamic | dynamic count | static | static count ]

Parameter

vlan-id ——The VLAN ID selected to display the information of all multicast
items.

ipv6_multicast_addr —— IPv6 address of the multicast group.
count—— The numbers of all multicast groups.
dynamic—— Display dynamic multicast groups.
147

dynamic count—— The numbers of all dynamic multicast groups.
static—— Display static multicast groups.
static count—— The numbers of all static multicast groups.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display all of the multicast groups:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld snooping groups

18.23 show ipv6 mld profile
Description
The show ipv6 mld profile command is used to display the configuration
information of all the profiles or a specific profile.

Syntax
show ipv6 mld profile [ id ]

Parameter
id —— Specify the ID of the profile, ranging from 1 to 999.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration information of all profiles:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 mld profile

148

Chapter 19 MVR Commands
MVR (Multicast VLAN Registration) allows a single multicast VLAN to be shared for multicast

member ports in different VLANs in IPv4 network. In IGMP Snooping, if member ports are in
different VLANs, a copy of the multicast streams is sent to each VLAN that has member ports.

While MVR provides a dedicated multicast VLAN to forward multicast traffic over the Layer 2
network, to avoid duplication of multicast streams for clients in different VLANs. Clients can
dynamically join or leave the multicast VLAN without interfering with their relationships in other
VLANs.

19.1

mvr (global)
Description
The mvr command is used to enable MVR globally. To disable MVR, please
use no mvr command.

Syntax

mvr
no mvr

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable MVR globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr

19.2

mvr group
Description
The mvr group command is used to add multicast groups to MVR. To delete

multicast groups from MVR, please use no mvr group command.

Syntax

mvr group ip-addr [count ]

149

no mvr group ip-addr [count ]

Parameter

ip-addr —— The start IP address of the contiguous series of multicast

groups.

count —— The number of the multicast groups to be added to the MVR. Valid

values are from 1 to 256, and the default value is 1.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Add multicast groups 225.1.2.3 -239.1.2.5 to MVR:
T1600G-28TS (config)# mvr group 225.1.2.3 3

19.3

mvr mode
Description

Syntax

The mvr mode command is used to configure the MVR mode as compatible
or dynamic. By default, it is compatible. To return to the default configuration,
please use no mvr mode command.
mvr mode { compatible | dynamic }

no mvr mode

Parameter

compatible —— In this mode, the switch does not forward report or leave

messages from the hosts to the IGMP querier. So the IGMP querier cannot
learn the multicast groups membership information from the switch. You have

to statically configure the IGMP querier to transmit all the required multicast
streams to the switch via the multicast VLAN.

dynamic —— In this mode, after receiving report or leave messages from the
hosts, the switch will forward them to the IGMP querier via the multicast VLAN
(with appropriate translation of the VLAN ID). So the IGMP querier can learn

the multicast groups membership information through the report and leave
messages, and transmit the multicast streams to the switch via the multicast
VLAN according to the multicast forwarding table.
150

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the MVR mode as dynamic:
T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr mode dynamic

19.4

mvr querytime
Description
The mvr querytime command is used to configure the maximum time to wait

for IGMP report on a receiver port before removing the port from multicast
group membership. To return to the default configuration, please use no mvr

querytime command.

Syntax

mvr querytime time

no mvr querytime

Parameter

time —— The query response time. Valid values are from 1 to100 tenths of a
second, and the default value is 5 tenths of a second.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the query response time of MVR as 1 second, that is 10 tenths of a
second:

T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr querytime 10

151

19.5

mvr vlan
Description
The mvr vlan command is used to specify the multicast VLAN. By default, it is
VLAN 1. To return to the default configuration, please use no mvr vlan

command.

Syntax

mvr vlan vlan-id
no mvr vlan

Parameter

vlan-id —— The ID of the multicast VLAN. Valid values are from 1 to 4094.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the multicast VLAN as VLAN 10:
T1600G-28TS(config)# mvr vlan 10

19.6

mvr (interface)
Description
This command is used to enable MVR for specific interfaces. To disable MVR
for the interfaces, please use no mvr command. By default, it is disabled.

Syntax

mvr
no mvr

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.
152

Example

Enable MVR for port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr

19.7

mvr type
Description

The mvr type command is used to configure the MVR port type as receiver or

source. By default, the port is a non-MVR port. If you attempt to configure a
non-MVR port with MVR characteristics, the operation fails. To return to the
default configuration, please use no mvr type command.

Syntax

mvr type { source | receiver }
no mvr type

Parameter

source —— Configure the uplink ports that receive and send multicast data

on the multicast VLAN as source ports. Source ports should belong to the
multicast VLAN.

receiver —— Configure the ports that are connecting to the hosts as receiver

ports. A receiver port can only belong to one VLAN, and cannot belong to the
multicast VLAN.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the port 1/0/3 as a receiver port:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr type receiver

153

19.8

mvr immediate
Description
The mvr immediate command is used to enable the Fast Leave feature of

MVR for specified port. To disable the Fast Leave feature of MVR for specific
ports, please use no mvr immediate command.

Syntax

mvr immediate
no mvr immediate

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

User Guidelines

Only receiver ports support Fast Leave. Before enabling Fast Leave for a port,
make sure there is only a single receiver device connecting to the port.

Example

Enable the Fast Leave feature of MVR for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr immediate

19.9

mvr vlan (group)
Description
This command is used to statically add ports to an MVR group. Then the ports
can receive multicast traffic sent to the IP multicast address via the multicast
VLAN.

Syntax

mvr vlan vlan-id group ip-addr

Parameter

vlan-id —— The ID of the multicast VLAN. Valid values are from 1 to 4094.
ip-addr —— The IP address of the multicast group.

154

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

User Guidelines

This command applies to only receiver ports. The switch adds or removes the
receiver ports to the corresponding multicast groups by snooping the report

and leave messages from the hosts. You can also statically add a receiver port
to an MVR group.

Example

Add port 1/0/3 to MVR group 225.1.2.3 statically. The multicast VLAN is VLAN
10:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mvr vlan 10 group 225.1.2.3

19.10 show mvr
Description

The show mvr command is used to display the global configuration of MVR.

Syntax

show mvr

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the global configuration of mvr:
T1600G-28TS# show mvr

155

19.11 show mvr interface
Description
The show mvr interface command is used to display the MVR configurations

of specific interfaces.

Syntax

show mvr interface gigabitEthernet [port | port-list ]

Parameter

port ——The Ethernet port number.

port-list —— The list of Ethernet ports.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the MVR configuration of port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS# show mvr interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3

19.12 show mvr members
Description

The show mvr members command is used to display the membership

information of all MVR groups or the specified MVR group.

Syntax

show mvr members [ ip-addr ]

Parameter

ip-addr——The multicast IP address of the MVR group.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the membership information of all MVR groups:

156

T1600G-28TS# show mvr members

19.13 show mvr traffic
Description
The show mvr traffic command is used to display the statistics information
of all MVR groups.

Syntax

show mvr traffic

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the statistics information of all MVR groups:
T1600G-28TS# show mvr traffic

157

Chapter 20 MSTP Commands
MSTP (Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol), compatible with both STP and RSTP and subject to

IEEE 802.1s, can disbranch a ring network. STP is to block redundant links and backup links as
well as optimize paths.

20.1

debug spanning-tree
Description

The debug spanning-tree command is used to enable debuggning of

spanning-tree activities. To disable the debugging function, please use no

Syntax

debug spanning-tree command.

debug spanning-tree { all | bpdu receive | bpdu transmit | cmpmsg | errors |
flush | init | migration | proposals | roles | state | tc }

no debug spanning-tree { all | bpdu receive | bpdu transmit | cmpmsg | errors
| flush | init | migration | proposals | roles | state | tc }

Parameters

all —— Display all the spanning-tree debug messages.
bpdu receive —— Display the debug messages of the received
spanning-tree bridge protocol data unit (BPDU).

bpdu transmit —— Display the debug messages of the sent spanning-tree
BPDU.

cmpmsg —— Display the message priority debug messages.
errors —— Display the MSTP error debug messages.
flush —— Display the address table flushing debug messages.
init —— Display the data structure initialization debug messages.
migration —— Display the version migration debug messages.
proposals —— Display the MSTP handshake debug messages.
roles —— Display the MSTP interface role switchling debug messages.
state —— Display the MSTP interface state change debug messages.
tc —— Display the MSTP topology event debug messages.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode
158

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display all the spanning-tree debug messages:
T1600G-28TS# debug spanning-tree all

20.2

spanning-tree (global)
Description

The spanning-tree command is used to enable STP function globally. To

Syntax

disable the STP function, please use no spanning-tree command.
spanning-tree
no spanning-tree

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the STP function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree

20.3

spanning-tree (interface)
Description

The spanning-tree command is used to enable STP function for a port. To

Syntax

disable the STP function, please use no spanning-tree command.
spanning-tree
no spanning-tree

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)
159

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the STP function for port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree

20.4

spanning-tree common-config
Description

The spanning-tree common-config command is used to configure the

parameters of the ports for comparison in the CIST and the common
parameters of all instances. To return to the default configuration, please use

no spanning-tree common-config command. CIST (Common and Internal

Spanning Tree) is the spanning tree in a switched network, connecting all

Syntax

devices in the network.

spanning-tree common-config [ port-priority pri ] [ ext-cost ext-cost ]

[ int-cost int-cost ] [ portfast { enable | disable }] [ point-to-point { auto | open
| close }]

no spanning-tree common-config

Parameter

pri —— Port Priority, which must be multiple of 16 ranging from 0 to 240. By
default, the port priority is 128. Port Priority is an important criterion on
determining if the port connected to this port will be chosen as the root port.

In the same condition, the port with the highest priority will be chosen as the
root port. The lower value has the higher priority.

ext-cost —— External Path Cost, which is used to choose the path and

calculate the path costs of ports in different MST regions. It is an important

criterion on determining the root port. The lower value has the higher priority.
It ranges from o to 2000000. By default, it is 0 which is mean auto.

int-cost —— Internal Path Cost, which is used to choose the path and

calculate the path costs of ports in an MST region. It is an important criterion

on determining the root port. The lower value has the higher priority. By

160

default, it is automatic. It ranges from o to 2000000. By default, it is 0 which is
mean auto.

portfast —— Enable/ Disable Edge Port. By default, it is disabled. The edge

port can transit its state from blocking to forwarding rapidly without waiting
for forward delay.

point-to-point —— The P2P link status, with auto, open and close options. By
default, the option is auto. If the two ports in the P2P link are root port or
designated port, they can transit their states to forwarding rapidly to reduce
the unnecessary forward delay.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the STP function of port 1, and configure the Port Priority as 64,
ExtPath Cost as 100, IntPath Cost as 100, and then enable Edge Port:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree common-config port-priority 64
ext-cost 100 int-cost 100 portfast enable point-to-point open

20.5

spanning-tree mode
Description

The spanning-tree mode command is used to configure the STP mode of the

switch. To return to the default configurations, please use no spanning-tree

Syntax

mode command.

spanning-tree mode { stp | rstp | mstp }
no spanning-tree mode

Parameter

stp ——Spanning Tree Protocol, the default value.
rstp ——Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol
mstp ——Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol
161

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the spanning-tree mode as mstp:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mode mstp

20.6

spanning-tree mst configuration
Description

The spanning-tree mst configuration command is used to access MST

Configuration Mode from Global Configuration Mode, as to configure the
VLAN-Instance mapping, region name and revision level. To return to the

default configuration of the corresponding Instance, please use no

Syntax

spanning-tree mst configuration command.
spanning-tree mst configuration
no spanning-tree mst configuration

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enter into the MST configuration mode:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration
T1600G-28TS(Config-mst)#

20.7

instance
Description

The instance command is used to configure the VLAN-Instance mapping. To

remove the VLAN-instance mapping or disable the corresponding instance,
162

please use no instance command. When an instance is disabled, the related

Syntax

mapping VLANs will be removed.

instance instance-id vlan vlan-id

no instance instance-id [ vlan vlan-id ]

Parameters

instance-id —— Instance ID, ranging from 1 to 8.

vlan-id —— The VLAN ID selected to mapping with the corresponding

instance.

Command Mode

MST Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Map the VLANs 1-100 to Instance 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration
T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# instance 1 vlan 1-100
Disable Instance 1, namely remove all the mapping VLANs 1-100:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration
T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# no instance 1
Remove VLANs 1-50 in mapping VLANs 1-100 for Instance 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration
T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# no instance 1 vlan 1-50

20.8

name
Description
Syntax

The name command is used to configure the region name of MST instance.
name name

163

Parameters

name —— The region name, used to identify MST region. It ranges from 1 to
32 characters.

Command Mode

MST Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the region name of MST as “region1”:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration
T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# name region1

20.9

revision
Description

The revision command is used to configure the revision level of MST

Syntax

instance.

revision revision

Parameters

revision —— The revision level for MST region identification, ranging from 0

to 65535.

Command Mode

MST Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the revision level of MST as 100:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst configuration
T1600G-28TS(config-mst)# revision 100

164

20.10 spanning-tree mst instance
Description

The spanning-tree mst instance command is used to configure the priority

of MST instance. To return to the default value of MST instance priority,

Syntax

please use no spanning-tree mst instance command.
spanning-tree mst instance instance-id priority pri

no spanning-tree mst instance instance-id priority

Parameter

instance-id —— Instance ID, ranging from 1 to 8.

pri —— MSTI Priority, which must be multiple of 4096 ranging from 0 to

61440. By default, it is 32768. MSTI priority is an important criterion on

determining if the switch will be chosen as the root bridge in the specific
instance.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the MST Instance 1 and configure its priority as 4096:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree mst instance 1 priority 4096

20.11 spanning-tree mst
Description

The spanning-tree mst command is used to configure MST Instance Port. To

return to the default configuration of the corresponding Instance Port, please
use no spanning-tree mst command. A port can play different roles in
different spanning tree instance. You can use this command to configure the

parameters of the ports in different instance IDs as well as view status of the

Syntax

ports in the specified instance.

spanning-tree mst instance instance-id {[ port-priority pri ] | [ cost cost ]}
165

no spanning-tree mst instance instance-id

Parameter

instance-id —— Instance ID, ranging from 1 to 8.

pri —— Port Priority, which must be multiple of 16 ranging from 0 to 240. By
default, it is 128. Port Priority is an important criterion on determining if the
port will be chosen as the root port by the device connected to this port.

cost —— Path Cost, ranging from 0 to 200000. The lower value has the
higher priority. Its default value is 0 meaning “auto”.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the priority of port 1 in MST Instance 1 as 64, and path cost as
2000:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree mst instance 1 port-priority 64
cost 2000

20.12 spanning-tree priority
Description

The spanning-tree priority command is used to configure the bridge priority.

To return to the default value of bridge priority, please use no spanning-tree

Syntax

priority command.

spanning-tree priority pri

no spanning-tree priority

Parameter

pri —— Bridge priority, ranging from 0 to 61440. It is 32768 by default.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

166

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the bridge priority as 4096:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree priority 4096

20.13 spanning-tree timer
Description

The spanning-tree timer command is used to configure forward-time,

hello-time and max-age of Spanning Tree. To return to the default

Syntax

configurations, please use no spanning-tree timer command.

spanning-tree timer {[ forward-time forward-time ] [ hello-time hello-time ]
[ max-age max-age ]}

no spanning-tree timer

Parameter

forward-time —— Forward Delay, which is the time for the port to transit its

state after the network topology is changed. Forward Delay ranges from 4 to

30 in seconds and it is 15 by default. Otherwise, 2 * (Forward Delay - 1) >=

Max Age.

hello-time ——Hello Time, which is the interval to send BPDU packets, and

used to test the links. Hello Time ranges from 1 to 10 in seconds and it is 2 by
default. Otherwise, 2 * (Hello Time + 1) <= Max Age.

max-age —— The maximum time the switch can wait without receiving a
BPDU before attempting to reconfigure, ranging from 6 to 40 in seconds. By
default, it is 20.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure forward-time, hello-time and max-age for Spanning Tree as 16

seconds, 3 seconds and 22 seconds respectively:
167

T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree timer forward-time 16 hello-time 3
max-age 22

20.14 spanning-tree hold-count
Description

The spanning-tree hold-count command is used to configure the maximum
number of BPDU packets transmitted per Hello Time interval. To return to the

Syntax

default configurations, please use no spanning-tree hold-count command.
spanning-tree hold-count value
no spanning-tree hold-count

Parameter

value —— The maximum number of BPDU packets transmitted per Hello Time
interval, ranging from 1 to 20 in pps. By default, it is 5.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the hold-count of STP as 8pps:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree hold-count 8

20.15 spanning-tree max-hops
Description

The spanning-tree max-hops command is used to configure the maximum

number of hops that occur in a specific region before the BPDU is discarded.

To return to the default configurations, please use no spanning-tree

Syntax

max-hops command.

spanning-tree max-hops value
no spanning-tree max-hops

168

Parameter

value —— The maximum number of hops that occur in a specific region
before the BPDU is discarded, ranging from 1 to 40 in hop. By default, it is 20.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the max-hops of STP as 30:
T1600G-28TS(config)# spanning-tree max-hops 30

20.16 spanning-tree bpdufilter
Description

The spanning-tree bpdufilter command is used to enable the BPDU filter

function for a port. With the function enabled, the port can be prevented from
receiving and sending any BPDU packets. To disable the BPDU filter function,

Syntax

please use no spanning-tree bpdufilter command.
spanning-tree bpdufilter
no spanning-tree bpdufilter

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the BPDU filter function for port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree bpdufilter

169

20.17 spanning-tree bpduflood
Description

The spanning-tree bpduflood command is used to enable the BPDU forward
function for a port. With the function enabled, the port still can forward

spanning tree BPDUs when the spanning tree function is disabled on this port.
To disable the BPDU filter function, please use no spanning-tree bpduflood

Syntax

command.

spanning-tree bpduflood
no spanning-tree bpduflood

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the BPDU forward function for port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree bpduflood

20.18 spanning-tree bpduguard
Description

The spanning-tree bpduguard command is used to enable the BPDU protect

function for a port. With the BPDU protect function enabled, the port will set
itself automatically as ERROR-PORT when it receives BPDU packets, and the

port will disable the forwarding function for a while. To disable the BPDU

Syntax

protect function, please use no spanning-tree bpduguard command.
spanning-tree bpduguard
no spanning-tree bpduguard

170

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the BPDU protect function for port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree bpduguard

20.19 spanning-tree guard loop
Description

The spanning-tree guard loop command is used to enable the Loop Protect

function for a port. Loop Protect is to prevent the loops in the network

brought by recalculating STP because of link failures and network
congestions. To disable the Loop Protect function, please use no

Syntax

spanning-tree guard loop command.
spanning-tree guard loop
no spanning-tree guard loop

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the Loop Protect function for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree guard loop

171

20.20 spanning-tree guard root
Description

The spanning-tree guard root command is used to enable the Root Protect
function for a port. With the Root Protect function enabled, the root bridge

will set itself automatically as ERROR-PORT when receiving BPDU packets

with higher priority, in order to maintain the role of root ridge. To disable the

Syntax

Root Protect function, please use no spanning-tree guard root command.
spanning-tree guard root
no spanning-tree guard root

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the Root Protect function for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree guard root

20.21 spanning-tree guard tc
Description

The spanning-tree guard tc command is used to enable the TC Protect of

Spanning Tree function for a port. To disable the TC Protect of Spanning Tree

function, please use no spanning-tree guard tc command. A switch removes
MAC address entries upon receiving TC-BPDUs. If a malicious user

continuously sends TC-BPDUs to a switch, the switch will be busy with

removing MAC address entries, which may decrease the performance and
stability of the network. With the Protect of Spanning Tree function enabled,

you can configure the number of TC-BPDUs in a required time, so as to avoid

Syntax

the process of removing MAC addresses frequently.
spanning-tree guard tc
172

no spanning-tree guard tc

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the TC Protect of Spanning Tree for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree guard tc

20.22 spanning-tree mcheck
Description
Syntax

The spanning-tree mcheck command is used to enable mcheck.
spanning-tree mcheck

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable mcheck for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# spanning-tree mcheck

20.23 show spanning-tree active
Description

The show spanning-tree active command is used to display the active

information of spanning-tree.

173

Syntax

show spanning-tree active

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the active information of spanning-tree:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree active

20.24 show spanning-tree bridge
Description

The show spanning-tree bridge command is used to display the bridge

Syntax

parameters.

show spanning-tree bridge [ forward-time | hello-time | hold-count | max-age

| max-hops | mode | priority | state ]

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the bridge parameters:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree bridge

20.25 show spanning-tree interface
Description

The show spanning-tree interface command is used to display the

spanning-tree information of all ports or a specified port.

174

Syntax

show spanning-tree interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel

port-channel-id ] [ edge | ext-cost | int-cost | mode | p2p | priority | role | state |
status ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the spanning-tree information of all ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface
Display the spanning-tree information of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/2
Display the spanning-tree mode information of port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/2 mode

20.26 show spanning-tree interface-security
Description

The show spanning-tree interface-security command is used to display the

Syntax

protect information of all ports or a specified port.
show

spanning-tree

interface-security

[

gigabitEthernet

port

|

port-channel port-channel-id ] [ bpdufilter | bpduflood | bpduguard | loop |

root | tc ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.
175

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the protect information of all ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface-security
Display the protect information of port 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface-security
gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
Display the interface security bpdufilter information:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show spanning-tree interface-security bpdufilter

20.27 show spanning-tree mst
Description

The show spanning-tree mst command is used to display the related

Syntax

information of MST Instance.

show spanning-tree mst { configuration [ digest ] | instance instance-id
[ interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ] ] }

Parameter

instance-id —— Instance ID desired to show, ranging from 1 to 8.
port —— The Ethernet port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the region information and mapping information of VLAN and MST
Instance:

T1600G-28TS(config)#show spanning-tree mst configuration
176

Display the related information of MST Instance 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show spanning-tree mst instance 1
Display all the ports information of MST Instance 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show spanning-tree mst instance 1 interface

177

Chapter 21 LLDP Commands
LLDP function enables network devices to advertise their own device information periodically

to neighbors on the same LAN. The information of the LLDP devices in the LAN can be stored
by its neighbor in a standard MIB, so it is possible for the information to be accessed by a
Network Management System (NMS) using SNMP.

21.1

lldp
Description

The lldp command is used to enable LLDP function. To disable the LLDP

Syntax

function, please use no lldp command.
lldp
no lldp

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable LLDP function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp

21.2

lldp forward_message
Description
The lldp forward_message command is used to enable the switch to forward
LLDP messages when LLDP function is disabled. To disable the LLDP
messages forwarding function, please use no lldp forward_message
command.

Syntax

lldp forward_message
no lldp forward_message

178

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the switch to forward LLDP messages when LLDP function is disabled
globally:

T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp forward_message

21.3

lldp hold-multiplier
Description

The lldp hold-multiplier command is used to configure the Hold Multiplier

parameter. The aging time of the local information in the neighbor device is

determined by the actual TTL value used in the sending LLDPDU. TTL = Hold

Multiplier * Transmit Interval. To return to the default configuration, please

Syntax

use no lldp hold-multiplier command.
lldp hold-multiplier multiplier
no lldp hold-multiplier

Parameter

multiplier —— Configure the Hold Multiplier parameter. It ranges from 2 to 10.
By default, it is 4.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify Hold Multiplier as 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp hold-multiplier 5

179

21.4

lldp timer
Description

The lldp timer command is used to configure the parameters about

transmission. To return to the default configuration, please use no lldp timer

Syntax

command.

lldp timer { tx-interval tx-interval | tx-delay tx-delay | reinit-delay reinit-delay

| notify-interval notify-interval | fast-count fast-count }

no lldp timer { tx-interval | tx-delay | reinit-delay | notify-interval | fast-count }

Parameter

tx-interval —— Configure the interval for the local device to transmit LLDPDU
to its neighbors. The value ranges from 5 to 32768 and the default value is 30
seconds.

tx-delay —— Configure a value from 1 to 8192 in seconds to specify the time

for the local device to transmit LLDPDU to its neighbors after changes occur
so as to prevent LLDPDU being sent frequently. By default, it is 2 seconds.

reinit-delay —— This parameter indicates the amount of delay from when

LLDP status becomes "disable" until re-initialization will be attempted. The
value ranges from 1 to 10 and the default value is 2.

notify-interval —— Specify the interval of Trap message which will be sent

from local device to network management system. The value ranges from 5
to 3600 and the default value is 5 seconds.

fast-count —— When the port's LLDP state transforms from Disable (or
Rx_Only) to Tx&Rx (or Tx_Only), the fast start mechanism will be enabled, that

is, the transmit interval will be shorten to a second, and several LLDPDUs will

be sent out (the number of LLDPDUs equals this parameter). The value ranges
from 1 to 10 and the default value is 3.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the Transmit Interval of LLDPDU as 45 seconds and Trap message to
NMS as 120 seconds:

180

T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp timer tx-interval 45
T1600G-28TS(config)#lldp timer notify-interval 120

21.5

lldp receive
Description

The lldp receive command is used to enable the designated port to receive

Syntax

LLDPDU. To disable the function, please use no lldp receive command.
lldp receive
no lldp receive

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable port 1/0/1 to receive LLDPDU:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#lldp receive

21.6

lldp transmit
Description

The lldp transmit command is used to enable the designated port to transmit

Syntax

LLDPDU. To disable the function, please use no lldp transmit command.
lldp transmit
no lldp transmit

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

181

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1 to transmit LLDPDU:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#lldp transmit

21.7

lldp snmp-trap
Description

The lldp snmp-trap command is used to enable the port’s SNMP notification.
If enabled, the port will notify the trap event to network management system.
To disable the ports' SNMP notification, please use no lldp snmp-trap

Syntax

command.

lldp snmp-trap
no lldp snmp-trap

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the SNMP notification for Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#lldp snmp-trap

182

21.8

lldp tlv-select
Description

The lldp tlv-select command is used to configure TLVs to be included in

outgoing LLDPDU. To exclude TLVs, please use no lldp tlv-select command.

Syntax

By default, All TLVs are included in outgoing LLDPDU.

lldp tlv-select { [ port-description ] [ system-capability ] [ system-description ]

[ system-name ] [ management-address ] [ port-vlan ] [ protocol-vlan ]

[ vlan-name ] [ link-aggregation ] [ mac-phy-cfg ] [ max-frame-size ] [ power ]

[ all ] }
no

lldp

tlv-select

{

[

port-description

]

[

system-capability

]

[ system-description ] [ system-name ] [ management-address ] [ port-vlan ]

[ protocol-vlan ] [ vlan-name ] [ link-aggregation ] [ mac-phy-cfg ]

[ max-frame-size ] [ power ] [ all ] }

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Exclude “management-address” and “port-vlan-id” TLVs in LLDPDU outgoing

from Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no lldp tlv-select management-address port-vlan

21.9

lldp management-address
Description

The lldp management-address command is used to configure the port‘s

management address to be included in management address TLV. The NMS

uses management addresses to identify the devices. To delete the port‘s
management address, please use no lldp management address command.

183

Syntax

lldp management-address { ip-address }
no lldp management-address

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the port‘s management address as 192.168.1.100 for port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lldp management-address 192.168.0.100

21.10 lldp med-fast-count
Description

The lldp med-fast-count command is used to configure the number of the

LLDP-MED frames that will be sent out. When LLDP-MED fast start

mechanism is activated, multiple LLDP-MED frames will be transmitted based

on this parameter. The default value is 4. To return to the default

Syntax

configuration, please use no lldp med-fast-count command.
lldp med-fast-count count
no lldp med-fast-count

Parameter

count —— Configure the Fast Start Count parameter. It ranges from 1 to 10.
By default, it is 4.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Specify Fast Start Count as 5:
184

T1600G-28TS(config)# lldp med-fast-count 5

21.11 lldp med-status
Description

The lldp med-status command is used to enable the LLDP-MED feature for

the corresponding port. After the LLDP-MED feature is enabled, the port's
Admin Status will be changed to Tx&Rx. To disable the LLDP-MED feature for

Syntax

the corresponding port, please use no lldp med-status command.
lldp med-status
no lldp med-status

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable the LLDP-MED feature for port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lldp med-status

21.12 lldp med-tlv-select
Description

The lldp med-tlv-select command is used to configure LLDP-MED TLVs to

be included in outgoing LLDPDU for the corresponding port. To exclude

LLDP-MED TLVs, please use no lldp med-tlv-select command. By default, All

Syntax

TLVs are included in outgoing LLDPDU.

lldp med-tlv-select { [inventory-management] [location] [network-policy]
[power-management] [all] }

no lldp med-tlv-select { [inventory-management] [location] [network-policy]
[power-management] [all] }

185

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Exclude “network policy” and “inventory” TLVs in LLDPDU outgoing from port
1/0/2:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no lldp med-tlv-select network-policy inventorymanagement

21.13 lldp med-location
Description

The lldp med-location command is used to configure the Location

Syntax

Identification TLV's content in outgoing LLDPDU of the port.
lldp

med-location

{

emergency-number

identifier

|

civic-address

[ [ language language ] [ province-state province-state ] [ lci-county-name

county-name ] [ lci-city city ] [ street street ] [ house-number house-number ]

[name name ] [ postal-zipcode postal-zipcode ] [ room-number room-number ]

[ post-office-box post-office-box ] [ additional additional ] [ country-code

country-code ] [ what { dhcp-server | endpoint | switch } ] ] }

Parameter

emergency-number —— Emergency Call Service ELIN identifier, which is
used during emergency call setup to a traditional CAMA or ISDN trunk-based

PSAP. The length of this field ranges from 10 to 25 characters.

civic-address —— The civic address is defined to reuse the relevant

sub-fields of the DHCP option for civic Address based Location Configuration
Information as specified by IETF.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

186

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the civic address in the Location Identification TLV's content in
outgoing LLDPDU of port 1/0/2. Configure the language as English and city as
London:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# lldp med-location civic-address language English
lci-city London

21.14 show lldp
Description

The show lldp command is used to display the global configuration of LLDP.

Syntax

show lldp

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the global configuration of LLDP:
T1600G-28TS#show lldp

21.15 show lldp interface
Description

The show lldp interface command is used to display LLDP configuration of

the corresponding port. By default, the LLDP configuration of all the ports will
be displayed.

Syntax

show lldp interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]
187

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the LLDP configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS#show lldp interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

21.16 show lldp local-information interface
Description

The show lldp local-information interface command is used to display the
LLDP information of the corresponding port. By default, the LLDP information

Syntax

of all the ports will be displayed.

show lldp local-information interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the LLDP information of 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS#show lldp local-information interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

188

21.17 show lldp neighbor-information interface
Description

The show lldp neighbor-information interface command is used to display

the neighbor information of the corresponding port. By default, the neighbor
information of all the ports will be displayed.

Syntax

show lldp neighbor-information interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the neighbor information of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS#show lldp neighbor-information interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/1

21.18 show lldp traffic interface
Description

The show lldp traffic interface command is used to display the LLDP

statistic information between the local device and neighbor device of the
corresponding port. By default, the LLDP statistic information of all the ports

Syntax

will be displayed.

show lldp traffic interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
189

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the LLDP statistic information of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS#show lldp traffic interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

190

Chapter 22 Static Routes Commands
22.1

ip routing
Description
This ip routing command is used to enable IPv4 routing globally. To disable
IPv4 routing, please use the no ip routing command.

Syntax
ip routing
no ip routing

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable IPv4 routing feature for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip routing

22.2

interface vlan
Description
This interface vlan command is used to create the VLAN interface. To delete

the specified VLAN interface, please use the no interface vlan command.

Syntax
interface vlan { vid }

no interface vlan { vid }

Parameter
vid —— The ID of the VLAN.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode
191

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the VLAN interface 2:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2

22.3

interface loopback
Description
This interface loopback command is used to create the loopback interface.
To delete the specified loopback interface, please use the no interface
loopback command.

Syntax
interface loopback { id }

no interface loopback { id }

Parameter
id —— The ID of the loopback interface, ranging from 1 to 64.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the loopback interface 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface loopback 1

22.4

switchport
Description
This switchport command is used to switch the Layer 3 interface into the
Layer 2 port. To switch the Layer 2 port into the Layer 3 routed port, please
use the no switchport command.
192

Syntax
switchport
no switchport

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Switch port 1/0/9 into the routed port:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/9
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport

22.5

interface range port-channel
Description
This interface range port-channel command is used to create multiple

port-channel interfaces.

Syntax
interface range port-channel port-channel-list

Parameter
port-channel-list —— The list of the port-channel interface, ranging from 1 to
14, in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the port-channel interfaces 1, 3, 4 and 5:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface port-channel 1,3-5
193

22.6

description
Description
This description command is used to add a description to the Layer 3
interface, including routed port, port-channel interface, loopback interface

and VLAN interface. To clear the description of the corresponding interface,
please use the no description command.

Syntax

description string
no description

Parameter
string —— Content of an interface description, ranging from 1 to 32

characters.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Add a description system-if to the routed port 1/0/9 :

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/9
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport

T1600G-28TS(config-if)# description system-if

22.7

shutdown
Description
This shutdown command is used to shut down the specified interface. The

interface type include: routed port, port-channel interface, loopback interface

and VLAN interface. To enable the specified interface, please use the no
shutdown command.

Syntax
shutdown
194

no shutdown

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Shut down the routed port 1/0/9:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/9
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# shutdown

22.8

interface port-channel
Description
This interface port-channel command is used to create the port-channel

interface. To delete the specified port-channel interface, please use the no

interface port-channel command.

Syntax
interface port-channel { port-channel-id }

no interface port-channel { port-channel-id }

Parameter
port-channel-id —— The ID of the port-channel interface, ranging from 1 to
14.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the port-channel interface 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface port-channel 1
195

22.9

ip route
Description
This ip route command is configure the static route. To clear the
corresponding entry, please use the no ip route command.

Syntax
ip route { dest-address } { mask } { next-hop-address } [ distance ]
no ip route { dest-address } { mask } { next-hop-address }

Parameter
dest-address —— The destination IP address.
mask —— The subnet mask.

next-hop-address —— The address of the next-hop.

distance —— The distance metric of this route, ranging from 1 to 255. The

smaller the distance is, the higher the priority is.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create a static route with the destination IP address as 192.168.2.0, the
subnet mask as 255.255.255.0 and the next-hop address as 192.168.0.2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip route 192.168.2.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.0.2

22.10 ipv6 routing
Description
This ipv6 routing command is enale the IPv6 routing feature globally. To
diable IPv6 routing, please use the no ipv6 routing command.

Syntax
ipv6 routing
no ipv6 routing
196

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable IPv6 routing globally:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 routing

22.11 ipv6 route
Description
This ipv6 route command is configure the IPv6 static route. To clear the
corresponding entry, please use the no ipv6 route command.

Syntax
ipv6 route { ipv6-dest-address } { next-hop-address } [ distance ]
no ipv6 route { ipv6-dest-address } { next-hop-address }

Parameter
ipv6-dest-address—— The IPv6 address of the destination network.
next-hop-address —— The IPv6 address of the next-hop.

distance —— The distance metric of this route, ranging from 1 to 255. The

smaller the distance is, the higher the priority is.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create a static route with the destination network IP address as 3200::/64 and
the next-hop address as 3100::1234:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 route 3200::/64 3100::1234

197

22.12 show interface vlan
Description

The show interface vlan command is used to display the information of the

Syntax

specified interface VLAN.
show interface vlan vid

Parameter

vid —— The VLAN ID.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the information of VLAN 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show interface vlan 2

22.13 show ip interface
Description
This show ip interface command is used to display the detailed information

of the specified Layer 3 interface.

Syntax
show ip interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id |

loopback id | vlan vlan-id ]

Parameter
port —— The port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel. Member ports in this port

channel should all be routed ports.

id —— The loopback interface ID.

vlan-id —— The VLAN interface ID.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
198

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the detailed information of the VLAN interface 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip interface vlan 2

22.14 show ip interface brief
Description
This show ip interface brief command is used to display the summary
information of the Layer 3 interfaces.

Syntax
show ip interface brief

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the summary information of the Layer 3 interfaces:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip interface brief

22.15 show ip route
Description
This show ip route command is used to display the route entries of the
specified type.

Syntax
show ip route [ static | connected ]

Parameter
static | connected —— Specify the route type. If not specified, all types of
route entries will be displayed.
static: The static routes.
199

connected: The connected routes.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the static routes:

T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route static

22.16 show ip route specify
Description
This show ip route specify command is used to display the valid routing
information to the specified IP address or network segments.

Syntax
show ip route specify { ip } [ mask ] [ longer-prefixes ]

Parameter
ip —— Specify the destination IP address.

mask —— Specify the destination IP address together with the parameter ip.
longer-prefixes —— Specify the destination subnets that match the network
segment determined by the ip and mask parameters.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the shortest route to 192.168.0.100:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route specify 192.168.0.100
Look up the route entry with the destination as 192.168.0.0/24:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route specify 192.168.0.0 255.255.255.0
Display the routes to all the subnets that belongs to 192.168.0.0/16:
200

T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route specify 192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0
longer-prefixes

22.17 show ip route summary
Description
This show ip route summary command is used to display the summary
information of the route entries classified by their sources.

Syntax
show ip route summary

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the summary information of route entries:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip route summary

22.18 show ipv6 interface
Description
This command is used to display the configured IPv6 information of the
management interface, including ipv6 function status, link-local address and

global address, IPv6 multicast groups etc.

Syntax
show ipv6 interface

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IPv6 information of the management interface:
201

T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 interface

22.19 show ipv6 route
Description
This show ipv6 route command is used to display the IPv6 route entries of
the specified type.

Syntax
show ipv6 route [ static | connected ]

Parameter
static | connected —— Specify the route type. If not specified, all types of
route entries will be displayed.
static: The static routes.
connected: The connected routes.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IPv6 static routes:

T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 route static

22.20 show ipv6 route summary
Description
This show ipv6 route summary command is used to display the summary
information of the IPv6 route entries classified by their sources.

Syntax
show ipv6 route summary

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

202

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the summary information of IPv6 route entries:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 route summary

203

Chapter 23 IPv6 Address Configuration Commands
The IPv6 address configuration commands are provided in the Interface Configuration Mode,
which includes the routed port, the port-channel interface and the VLAN interface. Enter the

configuration mode of these Layer 3 interfaces and configure their IPv6 parameters.

23.1

ipv6 enable
Description
This command is used to enable the IPv6 function on the specified Layer 3
interface. IPv6 function should be enabled before the IPv6 address

configuration management. By default it is enabled on VLAN interface 1. IPv6
function can only be enabled on one Layer 3 interface at a time.

If the IPv6 function is disabled, the corresponding IPv6-based modules will be

invalid, for example SSHv6, SSLv6, TFTPv6 and more. To disable the IPv6
function, please use no ipv6 enable command.

Syntax
ipv6 enable

no ipv6 enable

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the IPv6 function on the VLAN interface 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 enable

23.2

ipv6 address autoconfig
Description
This command is used to enable the automatic configuration of the ipv6

link-local address. The switch has only one ipv6 link-local address, which can

be configured automatically or manually. The general ipv6 link-local address
204

has the prefix as fe80::/10. IPv6 routers cannot forward packets that have

link-local source or destination addresses to other links. The autu-configured

ipv6 link-local address is in EUI-64 format. To verify the uniqueness of the

link-local address, the manually configured ipv6 link-local address will be

deleted when the auto-configured ipv6 link-local address takes effect.

Syntax
ipv6 address autoconfig

Configuration Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the automatic configuration of the ipv6 link-local address on VLAN
interface 1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address autoconfig

23.3

ipv6 address link-local
Description
The ipv6 address link-local command is used to configure the ipv6 link-local

address manually on a specified interface. To delete the configured link-local

address, please use no ipv6 address link-local command.

Syntax
ipv6 address ipv6-addr link-local
no ipv6 address ipv6-addr link-local

Parameter
ipv6-addr —— The link-local address of the interface. It should be a
standardized IPv6 address with the prefix fe80::/10, otherwise this command
will be invalid.

Configuration Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

205

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the link-local address as fe80::1234 on the VLAN interface 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address fe80::1234 link-local

23.4

ipv6 address dhcp
Description
The ipv6 address dhcp command is used to enable the DHCPv6 Client

function. When this function is enabled, the Layer 3 interface will try to obtain
IP from DHCPv6 server. To delete the allocated IP from DHCPv6 server and
disable the DHCPv6 Client function, please use no ipv6 address dhcp
command.

Syntax
ipv6 address dhcp
no ipv6 address dhcp

Configuration Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCP Client function on VLAN interface 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address dhcp

23.5

ipv6 address ra
Description
This command is used to configure the interface’s global IPv6 address

according to the address prefix and other configuration parameters from its
206

received RA(Router Advertisement) message. To disable this function, please
use no ipv6 address ra command.

Syntax
ipv6 address ra
no ipv6 address ra

Configuration Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the automatic ipv6 address configuration function to obtain IPv6
address through the RA message on VLAN interface 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address ra

23.6

ipv6 address eui-64
Description
This command is used to manually configure a global IPv6 address with an
extended unique identifier (EUI) in the low-order 64 bits on the interface.

Specify only the network prefix. The last 64 bits are automatically computed
from the switch MAC address. To remove a EUI-64 IPv6 address from the

interface, please use the no ipv6 address eui-64 command.

Syntax
ipv6 address ipv6-addr eui-64
no ipv6 address ipv6-addr eui-64

Parameter
ipv6-addr —— Global IPv6 address with 64 bits network prefix, for example
3ffe::/64.

Configuration Mode
Interface Configuration Mode
207

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure an EUI-64 global address on the interface with the network prefix
3ffe::/64:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address 3ffe::/64 eui-64

23.7

ipv6 address
Description
This command is used to manually configure a global IPv6 address on the

interface. To remove a global IPv6 address from the interface, please use no
ipv6 address command.

Syntax
ipv6 address ipv6-addr
no ipv6 address ipv6-addr

Parameter
ipv6-addr —— Global IPv6 address with network prefix, for example
3ffe::1/64.

Configuration Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the global address 3001::1/64 on VLAN interface 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ipv6 address 3001::1/64

208

23.8

show ipv6 interface
Description
This command is used to display the configured ipv6 information of the
management interface, including ipv6 function status, link-local address and

global address, ipv6 multicast groups etc.

Syntax
show ipv6 interface

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the ipv6 information of the management interface:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ipv6 interface

209

Chapter 24 ARP Commands
Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is used to resolve an IP address into an Ethernet MAC

address. The switch maintains an ARP mapping table to record the IP-to-MAC mapping

relations, which is used for forwarding packets. An ARP mapping table contains two types of

ARP entries: dynamic and static. An ARP dynamic entry is automatically created and maintained
by ARP. A static ARP entry is manually configured and maintained.

24.1

arp
Description
This arp command is used to add a static ARP entry. To delete the specified
ARP entry, please use the no arp command.

Syntax
arp ip mac type
no arp ip type

Parameter
ip —— The IP address of the static ARP entry.

mac —— The MAC address of the static ARP entry.
type —— The ARP type. Configure it as “arpa”.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create a static ARP entry with the IP as 192.168.0.1 and the MAC as
00:11:22:33:44:55:

T1600G-28TS(config)# arp 192.168.0.1 00:11:22:33:44:55 arpa

210

24.2

clear arp-cache
Description
This clear arp-cache command is used to clear all the dynamic ARP entries.

Syntax
clear arp-cache

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Clear all the dynamic ARP entries:

T1600G-28TS(config)# clear arp-cache

24.3

arp dynamicrenew

Description

This arp dynamicrenew command is used to automatically renew dynamic

ARP entries. To disable the switch to automatically renew dynamic ARP
entries, please use the no arp dynamicremew command. By default, it is
enabled.

Syntax
arp dynamicremew
no arp dynamicremew

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the switch to automatically renew the dynamic ARP entries:
T1600G-28TS(config)# arp dynamicrenew
211

24.4

arp timeout
Description
This arp timeout command is used to configure the ARP aging time of the
interface.

Syntax
arp timeout timeout

no arp timeout

Parameter
timeout —— Specify the aging time, ranging from 10 to 3000 seconds. The
default value is 1200 seconds.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the ARP aging time as 60 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# arp timeout 60

24.5

gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable
Description
This gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable command is used to enable the

Layer 3 interface to send a gratuitous ARP packet when the interface’s status
becomes up.

Syntax
gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable
no gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

212

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Enable the switch’s Layer 3 interfaces to send gratuitous ARP packets when
their status becomes up:

T1600G-28TS(config)# gratuitous-arp intf-status-up enable

24.6

gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable
Description
This gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable command is used to enable the

Layer 3 interface to send a gratuitous ARP packet when receiving a

gratuitous packets of which the IP address is the same as its own.

Syntax
gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable
no gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Enable the switch’s Layer 3 interface to send gratuitous ARP packets when
receiving a gratuitous packets of which the IP address is the same as its own:

T1600G-28TS(config)# gratuitous-arp dup-ip-detected enable

24.7

gratuitous-arp learning enable
Description
This gratuitous-arp learning enable command is used to enable the Layer 3
interface to learn MAC addresses from the gratuitous ARP packets.

Syntax
gratuitous-arp learning enable
no gratuitous-arp learning enable
213

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Enable the Layer 3 interface to learn MAC addresses from the gratuitous ARP
packets:

T1600G-28TS(config)# gratuitous-arp learning enable

24.8

gratuitous-arp send-interval
Description
This gratuitous-arp send-interval command is used to configure the interval

at which the interface periodically send the gratuitous ARP packets.

Syntax
gratuitous-arp send-interval interval

Parameter
Interval —— Specify the interval at which the interface periodically send the
gratuitous ARP packets. Value 0 means the interface will not send gratuitous
ARP packets.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface vlan / interface gigabitEthernet /

interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range
port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Specify the interface VLAN 1 to send gratuitous ARP packets every 1 second:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1

T1600G-28TS(config-if)# gratuitous-arp send-interval 1

214

24.9

ip proxy-arp
Description
The ip proxy-arp command is used to enable Proxy ARP function on the
specified VLAN interface or routed port. To disable Proxy ARP on this interface,
please use no ip proxy-arp command.

Syntax
ip proxy-arp
no ip proxy-arp

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
None

Example
Enable the Proxy ARP function on VLAN Interface 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip proxy-arp
Enable the Proxy ARP function on routed port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip proxy-arp

24.10 ip local-proxy-arp
Description
The ip local-proxy-arp command is used to enable Local Proxy ARP function
on the specified VLAN interface or routed port. To disable Local Proxy ARP
function on this interface, please use no ip local-proxy-arp command.

Syntax
ip local-proxy-arp
no ip local-proxy-arp

215

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (Interface vlan / interface gigabitEthernet /
interface range gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range
port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
None

Example
Enable the Proxy ARP function on VLAN Interface 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip local-proxy-arp
Enable the Proxy ARP function on routed port 1/0/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no switchport
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip local-proxy-arp

24.11 show arp
Description
This show arp command is used to display the active ARP entries. If no
parameter is speicified, all the active ARP entries will be displayed.

Syntax
show arp [ ip ] [ mac ]

Parameter
ip —— Specify the IP address of your desired ARP entry.

mac —— Specify the MAC address of your desired ARP entry.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

216

Example
Display the ARP entry with the IP as 192.168.0.2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show arp 192.168.0.2

24.12 show ip arp (interface)
Description
This show ip arp (interface) command is used to display the active ARP
entries associated with a specified Layer 3 interface.

Syntax
show ip arp { gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id | vlan id }

Parameter
port —— Specify the number of the routed port.

port-channel-id —— Specify the ID of the port channel.
id —— Specify the VLAN interface ID.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the ARP entry associated with VLAN interface 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip arp vlan 2

24.13 show ip arp summary
Description
This show ip arp summary command is used to display the number of the
active ARP entries.

Syntax
show ip arp summary

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
217

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the number of the ARP entries:

T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip arp summary

24.14 show gratuitous-arp
Description
This show gratuitous arp command is used to display the configuration of

gratuitous ARP.

Syntax
show gratuitous-arp

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of gratuitous ARP:

T1600G-28TS(config)# show gratuitous-arp

24.15 show ip proxy-arp
Description
The show ip proxy-arp command is used to display the Proxy ARP status.

Syntax
show ip proxy-arp

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None

218

Example
Display the Proxy ARP status:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip proxy-arp

219

Chapter 25 DHCP Server Commands
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) is a network configuration protocol for hosts on

TCP/IP networks, and it provides a framework for distributing configuration information to
hosts. DHCP server assigns IP addresses from specified address pools on a switch or router to

DHCP clients and manages them.

25.1

service dhcp server
Description
The service dhcp server command is used to enable DHCP service globally.
To disable DHCP server service, please use no service dhcp server
command.

Syntax
service dhcp server

no service dhcp server

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable DHCP server service globally:

T1600G-28TS(config)# service dhcp server

25.2

ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip
Description
The ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip command is used to
configure the IP address of the remote DHCP server. To delete the remote
DHCP server’s IP address, please use no ip dhcp server extend-option
capwap-ac-ip command.

Syntax

ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip ip-address

no ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip
220

Parameter

ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the remote server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the remote DHCP server’s IP address as 192.168.3.1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server extend-option capwap-ac-ip
192.168.3.1

25.3

ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id
Description
The ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id command is used to
configure the class ID of the packets from DHCP server in a different network
segment. To delete the class ID settings, please use no ip dhcp server
extend-option vendor-class-id command.

Syntax

ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id class-id
no ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id

Parameter

class-id —— Specify the class ID of the DHCP packets from another network
segment.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the class ID of the DHCP packets from another network segment as 34:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server extend-option vendor-class-id 34
221

25.4

ip dhcp server exclude-address
Description
The ip dhcp server exclude-address command is used to specify the
reserved IP addresses which are forbidden to allocate, such as the gateway
address, the network segment broadcast address, the server address etc. To
delete the reserved IP addresses, please use no ip dhcp server
exclude-address command.

Syntax

ip dhcp server exclude-address start-ip-address end-ip-address
no ip dhcp server exclude-address start-ip-addr end-ip-address

Parameter

start-ip-address —— Specify the start IP address of the reserved IP pool.

end-ip-address —— Specify the end IP address of the reserved IP pool. Only

one IP address will be reserved if the end IP address and the start IP address
are the same.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the reserved IP addresses from 192.168.1.1 to 192.168.1.9:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server exclude-address 192.168.1.1
192.168.1.9

25.5

ip dhcp server pool
Description
The ip dhcp server pool command is used to create the address pool of
DHCP Server and enter the dhcp configuration mode. To delete the address
pool, please use no ip dhcp server pool command.

Syntax

ip dhcp server pool pool-name

no ip dhcp server pool pool-name
222

Parameter

pool-name —— Specify the address pool name, ranging from 1 to 8

characters.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create the address pool of name POOL1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool POOL1

25.6

ip dhcp server ping timeout
Description
The ip dhcp server ping timeout command is used to specify the timeout of
PING process. To resume the default value, please use no ip dhcp server
ping timeout command.

Syntax

ip dhcp server ping timeout value
no ip dhcp server ping timeout

Parameter

value —— Specify the timeout value, ranging from 100 to 10000ms. The
default value is 100ms.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the timeout of PING as 200ms:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server ping timeout 200

223

25.7

ip dhcp server ping packets
Description
The ip dhcp server ping packets command is used to specify the number of
PING packets sent. If this value is set to 0, the PING process will be disabled.
To resume the default value, please use no ip dhcp server ping packets
command.

Syntax

ip dhcp server ping packets num

Parameter

num —— Specify the PING packets’ number, ranging from 0 to 10. By default

it’s 1.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the PING packets’ number as 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server ping packets 2

25.8

network
Description
The network command is used to specify the address and subnet of the
network pool.

Syntax

network network-address subnet-mask

Parameter

network-address —— Specify the network address of the pool, with the

format A.B.C.D. All the IP addresses in the same subnet are allocatable except
the reserved addresses and specific addresses.

subnet-mask —— Specify the subnet mask of the pool, with the format

A.B.C.D.

224

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the address pool “product” as 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# network 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0

25.9

lease
Description
The lease command is used to specify the lease time of the address pool.

Syntax

lease lease-time

Parameter

lease-time —— Specify the lease time of the pool, ranging from 1 to 2880

minutes. The default value is 120 minutes.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the lease time of address pool “product” as 10 minutes:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# lease 10

225

25.10 address hardware-address
Description
The address hardware-address command is used to reserve the static
address bound with hardware address in the address pool. To delete the
binding, please use no address hardware-address.

Syntax

address ip-address hardware-address hardware-address hardware-type
{ ethernet | ieee802 }
no address ip-address

Parameter

ip-address —— Specify the static binding IP address.

hardware-address —— Specify the hardware address, in the format
XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX.

ethernet | ieee802 —— Specify the hardware type.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Reserve the IP address 192.168.0.10 in the address pool “product” for the
device with the MAC address as 5e:4c:a6:31:24:01 and the hardware type as
ethernet:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# address 192.168.0.10 hardware-address
5e:4c:a6:31:24:01 hardware-type ethernet

25.11 address client-identifier
Description
The address client-identifier command is used to specify the static address
bound with client ID in the address pool. To delete the binding, please use no
address command.

226

Syntax

address ip-address client-identifier client-id [ascii]

no address ip-address

Parameter

ip-address —— Specify the static binding IP address.

client-id —— Specify the client ID, in the format of hex value.
ascii —— The client ID is entered with ASCII characters.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Reserve the IP address 192.168.0.10 in the address pool “product” for the
device with the client ID as abc in ASCII:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp pool product
T1600G-28TS(dhcp-config)# address 192.168.0.10 client-identifier abc
ascii

25.12 default-gateway
Description
The default-gateway command is used to specify the default gateway of the
address pool. To delete the configuration, please use no default-gateway.

Syntax

default-gateway gateway-list

no default-gateway

Parameter

gateway-list —— Specify the gateway list, with the format of A.B.C.D,E.F.G.H.
At most 8 gateways can be configured, separated by comma.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

227

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the address pool product’s default gateways as 192.168.0.1 and
192.168.1.1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(dhcp-config)# default-gateway 192.168.0.1,192.168.1.1

25.13 dns-server
Description
The dns-server command is used to specify the DNS server of the address
pool. To delete this configuration, please use no dns-server command.

Syntax

dns-server dns-list

no dns-server

Parameter

dns-list —— Specify the DNS server list, with the format of A.B.C.D,E.F.G.H. At
most 8 DNS servers can be configured, separated by comma.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the address pool’s DNS servers as 192.168.0.1 and 192.168.1.1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# dns-server 192.168.0.1,192.168.1.1

228

25.14 netbios-name-server
Description
The netbios-name-server command is used to specify the Netbios server’s
IP address. To delete the Netbios servers, please use no
netbios-name-server command.

Syntax

netbios-name-server NBNS-list
no netbios-name-server

Parameter

NBNS-list —— Specify the Netbios server list, with the format of

A.B.C.D,E.F.G.H. At most 8 Netbios servers can be configured, separated by
comma.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the address pool’s Netbios servers as 192.168.0.1 and 192.168.1.1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# netbios-name-server 192.168.0.1,192.168.1.1

25.15 netbios-node-type
Description
The netbios-node-type command is used to specify the Netbios server’s
node type. To delete the node type setttings, please use no
netbios-node-type command.

Syntax

netbios-node-type type
no netbios-node-type

Parameter

type —— Specify the node type as b-node, h-node, m-node or p-node.
229

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the address pool’s Netbios server type as b-node:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# netbios-node-type b-node

25.16 next-server
Description
The next-server command is used to specify the next DHCP server’s
address during the DHCP boot process. To delete the next server, please use
no next-server command.

Syntax

next-server ip-address

next-server

Parameter

ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the next server.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the next server’s IP address as 192.168.2.1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# next-server 192.168.2.1

230

25.17 domain-name
Description
The domain-name command is used to specify the domain name for the
DHCP client. To delete the domain name, please use no domain-name
command.

Syntax

domain-name domainname

no domain-name

Parameter

domainname —— Specify the domain name for the DHCP client.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the DHCP client’s domain name as edu:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# domain-name edu

25.18 bootfile
Description
The bootfilecommand is used to specify the name of the DHCP client’s
bootfile. To delete the bootfile, please use no bootfile command.

Syntax

bootfile file-name
no bootfile

Parameter

file-name —— Specify the name of the DHCP client’s bootfile.

Command Mode
DHCP Configuration Mode
231

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the name of the DHCP client’s bootfile as boot1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp server pool product
T1600G-28TS(config-dhcp)# bootfile boot1

25.19 show ip dhcp server status
Description
The show ip dhcp server status command is used to display the status of
the DHCP service.

Syntax
show ip dhcp server status

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the status of DHCP service:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server status

25.20 show ip dhcp server statistics
Description
The show ip dhcp server statistics command is used to display the DHCP
packets received and sent by DHCP server.

Syntax
show ip dhcp server statistics

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

232

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the statistics of DHCP packets received and sent by the DHCP server:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server statistics

25.21 show ip dhcp server extend-option
Description
The show ip dhcp server extend-option command is used to display the
configuration of the remote DCHP servers.

Syntax
show ip dhcp server extend-option

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configurations of the remote DCHP servers:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server extend-option

25.22 show ip dhcp server pool
Description
The show ip dhcp server pool command is used to display the configuration
of the address pool.

Syntax
show ip dhcp server pool

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

233

Example
Display the configured address pool:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server pool

25.23 show ip dhcp server excluded-address
Description
The show ip dhcp server excluded-address command is used to display the
configuration of reserved addresses.

Syntax
show ip dhcp server excluded-address

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configured reserved addresses:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server excluded-address

25.24 show ip dhcp server manual-binding
Description
The show ip dhcp server manual-binding command is used to display the
configuration of static binding address.

Syntax
show ip dhcp server manual-binding

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

234

Example
Display the configured static binding address:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server manual-binding

25.25 show ip dhcp server binding
Description
The show ip dhcp server binding command is used to display the binding
entries.

Syntax

show ip dhcp server binding [ ip ip-address ]

Parameter

ip-address —— Specify the binding IP address.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the address binding entries:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp server binding

25.26 clear ip dhcp server statistics
Description
The clear ip dhcp server statistics command is used to clear the statistics
information of DHCP packets.

Syntax
clear ip dhcp server statistics

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.
235

Example
Clear the packet statistics:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ip dhcp server statistics

25.27 clear ip dhcp server binding
Description
The clear ip dhcp server binding command is used to clear the binding
information.

Syntax

clear ip dhcp server binding [ ip-address ]

Parameter

ip-address —— Specify the binding IP address.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Clear all the binding addresses:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear ip dhcp server binding

236

Chapter 26 DHCP Relay Commands
A DHCP Relay agent is a Layer 3 device that forwards DHCP packets between clients and
servers. DHCP Relay forward requests and replies between clients and servers when they are
not on the same physical subnet.

26.1

service dhcp relay
Description
The service dhcp relay command is used to enable DHCP Relay function
globally. To disable DHCP Relay function, please use no service dhcp relay
command.

Syntax
service dhcp relay

no service dhcp relay

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable DHCP Relay function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# service dhcp relay

26.2

ip dhcp relay hops
Description
The ip dhcp relay hops command is used to specify the maximum hops
(DHCP Relay agent) that the DHCP packets can be relayed. To restore the
default value, please use no service dhcp relay hops command.

Syntax

ip dhcp relay hops hops

no ip dhcp relay hops

237

Parameter

hops ——Specify the maximum hops (DHCP Relay agent) that the DHCP

packets can be relayed. If a packet’s hop count is more than the value you set
here, the packet will be dropped. The valid value ranges from the 1 to 16, and
the default value is 4.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum number of relay hops as 6:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp relay hops 6

26.3

ip dhcp relay time
Description
The ip dhcp relay time command is used to specify the DHCP relay time
threshold. DHCP relay time is the time elapsed since client began address
acquisition or renewal process. When the elapsed time of the DHCP packet is
greater than the value set here, the DHCP packet will be dropped by the
switch. To restore the default value, please use no service dhcp relay time
command.

Syntax

ip dhcp relay time time
no ip dhcp relay time

Parameter

time ——Specify the DHCP relay time threshold. The valid value ranges from

1 to 65535. The default value is 0, which means the switch will not examine
this field of the DHCP packets.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

238

Example
Configure the DHCP Relay time as 30 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp relay time 30

26.4

ip helper-address
Description
The ip helper-address command is used to add DHCP Server address to the
Layer 3 interface. To delete the server address, please use no ip
helper-address command.

Syntax

ip helper-address ip-address

no ip helper-address [ ip-address ]

Parameter
ip-address —— DHCP Server address.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Add DHCP Server address 192.168.2.1 to interface VLAN 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip helper-address 192.168.2.1

26.5

ip dhcp relay information
Description
The ip dhcp relay information command is used to enable option 82 support
in DHCP Relay. To disable this function, please use no ip dhcp relay
information command.

Syntax
ip dhcp relay information

no ip dhcp relay information
239

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet/interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable option 82 support in DHCP Relay for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information

26.6

ip dhcp relay information strategy
Description
The ip dhcp relay information strategy command is used to specify the
operation for the Option 82 field of the DHCP request packets from the Host.
To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp relay information
strategy command.

Syntax
ip dhcp relay information strategy { drop | keep | replace }

no ip dhcp relay information strategy

Parameter
drop | keep | replace ——The operations for Option 82 field of the DHCP
request packets from the Host. The default operation is keep.
drop: Discard the packet with the Option 82 field.
keep: Keep the Option 82 field in the packet.

replace: Replace the option 82 field with the system option defined by the
switch.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

240

Example
Specify the option 82 strategy as replace to replace the Option 82 field with
the local parameter on receiving the DHCP request packet for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information strategy replace

26.7

ip dhcp relay information format
Description
The ip dhcp relay information format command is used to select the format

of option 82 sub-option value field. To restore to the default option, please
use no ip dhcp relay information format command.

Syntax
ip dhcp relay information format { normal | private }
no ip dhcp relay information format

Parameter
normal | private —— The format type of option 82 sub-option value field.
normal: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is TLV

(type-length-value).

private: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is the value you

configure for the related sub-option.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Select the format of option 82 sub-option value field as TLV
(type-length-value) for port 2:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp relay information format normal

241

26.8

ip dhcp relay information circuit-id
Description
The ip dhcp relay information circuit-id command is used to specify the
custom circuit ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the
circuit ID, please use no ip dhcp relay information circuit-id command.

Syntax

ip dhcp relay information circuit-id circuitID

no ip dhcp relay information circuit-id

Parameter

circuitID —— Specify the circuit ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the circuit ID as “TP-Link” for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information circuit-id TP-Link

26.9

ip dhcp relay information remote-id
Description
The ip dhcp relay information remote-id command is used to specify the
custom remote ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the
remote ID, please use no ip dhcp relay information remote-id command.

Syntax

ip dhcp relay information remote-id remoteID

no ip dhcp relay information remote-id

Parameter

remoteID —— Specify the remote ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters.

242

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the remote ID as “TP-Link” for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay information remote-id TP-Link

26.10 ip dhcp relay default-interface
Description
The ip dhcp relay default-interface command is used to configure default
relay agent interface. When the switch works at DHCP VLAN Relay mode and
there is no IP interface in the VLAN, the switch uses the IP of default relay
agent interface to fill in the relay agent IP address field of DHCP packets. To
delete the default relay agent interface use no ip dhcp relay
default-interface.

Syntax
ip dhcp relay default-interface

no ip dhcp relay default-interface

Command mode
Interface Configuration Mode
Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.
Example
Configure interface VLAN 1 as the default relay agent interface:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface vlan 1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp relay default-interface

243

26.11 ip dhcp relay vlan
Description
The ip dhcp relay vlan command is used to add DHCP server address to
specified VLAN. If there is an IP interface in the VLAN and it has configured a
DHCP server address at the interface level, then the configuration at the
interface level has higher priority. In this case, the DHCP server configured on
the VLAN will not be used to forward the DHCP packets. To delete the DHCP
server address use no ip dhcp relay vlan.

Syntax

ip dhcp relay vlan vid helper-address ip-address

no ip dhcp relay vlan vid helper-address [ ip-address ]

Parameter
vid —— VLAN ID.
ip-address —— DHCP Server address.

Command mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Add DHCP server address 192.168.2.1 to VLAN 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp relay vlan 1 helper-address 192.168.2.1

26.12 show ip dhcp relay
Description
The show ip dhcp relay command is used to display the global status and
Option 82 configuration of DHCP Relay.

Syntax
show ip dhcp relay

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

244

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of DHCP Relay:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp relay

245

Chapter 27 DHCP L2 Relay Commands
27.1

ip dhcp l2relay
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay command is used to enable DHCP L2 Relay function
globally. To disable DHCP L2 Relay function, please use no ip dhcp l2relay
command.

Syntax
ip dhcp l2relay

no ip dhcp l2relay

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable DHCP L2 Relay function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp l2relay

27.2

ip dhcp l2relay vlan
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay vlan command is used to enable DHCP L2 relay in the
specified VLAN. To disable DHCP L2 Relay in the specific vlan, please use no
ip dhcp l2relay vlan command.

Syntax

ip dhcp l2relay vlan vlan-range

no ip dhcp l2relay vlan vlan-range

Parameter

vlan-range —— Specify the vlan to be enabled with DHCP L2 relay.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode
246

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable DHCP L2 Relay for VLAN 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip dhcp l2relay vlan 2

27.3

ip dhcp l2relay information
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay information command is used to enable option 82
support in DHCP Relay. To disable this function, please use no ip dhcp
l2relay information command.

Syntax
ip dhcp l2relay information

no ip dhcp l2relay information

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable option 82 support in DHCP Relay for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information

27.4

ip dhcp l2relay information strategy
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay information strategy command is used to specify the
operation for the Option 82 field of the DHCP request packets from the Host.
To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information
strategy command.

247

Syntax
ip dhcp l2relay information strategy { drop | keep | replace }

no ip dhcp l2relay information strategy

Parameter
drop | keep | replace —— The operations for Option 82 field of the DHCP
request packets from the Host. The default operation is keep.
drop: Discard the packet with the Option 82 field.
keep: Keep the Option 82 field in the packet.

replace: Replace the option 82 field with the system option defined by the
switch.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the option 82 strategy as replace to replace the Option 82 field with
the local parameter on receiving the DHCP request packet for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information strategy replace

27.5

ip dhcp l2relay information format
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay information format command is used to select the
format of option 82 sub-option value field. To restore to the default option,
please use no ip dhcp l2relay information format command.

Syntax
ip dhcp l2relay information format { normal | private }
no ip dhcp l2relay information format

Parameter
normal | private —— The format type of option 82 sub-option value field.

248

normal: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is TLV

(type-length-value).

private: Indicates that the format of sub-option value field is the value you

configure for the related sub-option.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Select the format of option 82 sub-option value field as TLV
(type-length-value) for port 2:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp l2relay information format normal

27.6

ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id command is used to specify the
custom circuit ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the
circuit ID, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id command.

Syntax

ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id circuitID

no ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id

Parameter

circuitID —— Specify the circuit ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

249

Example
Specify the circuit ID as “TP-Link” for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information circuit-id TP-Link

27.7

ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id
Description
The ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id command is used to specify the
custom remote ID when option 82 customization is enabled. To clear the
remote ID, please use no ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id command.

Syntax

ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id remoteID

no ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id

Parameter

remoteID —— Specify the remote ID, ranging from 1 to 64 characters.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the remote ID as “TP-Link” for port 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# ip dhcp l2relay information remote-id TP-Link

27.8

show ip dhcp l2relay
Description
The show ip dhcp l2relay command is used to display the global status and
Option 82 configuration of DHCP Relay.

Syntax
show ip dhcp l2relay
250

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of DHCP Relay:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp l2relay

27.9

show ip dhcp l2relay interface
Description
The show ip dhcp l2relay interface command is used to display the DHCP
L2 Relay status for the ports.

Syntax

show ip dhcp l2relay interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel
port-channel-id ]

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of DHCP L2 Relay:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip dhcp l2relay interface

251

Chapter 28 QoS Commands
QoS (Quality of Service) function is used to optimize the network performance. It provides you
with network service experience of a better quality. The switch implements three priority
modes based on port, on 802.1p and on DSCP.

28.1

qos trust mode
Description

The qos trust mode command is used to configure the trust mode of CoS
(Class of Service) function for the ports. The default trust mode is trust port

Syntax

priority.

qos trust mode { dot1p | dscp | untrust }

Parameter

dot1p—— Trust 802.1p mode. In this mode, data will be classified into
different services based on the 802.1p priority.

dscp—— Trust dscp mode. In this mode, data will be classified into different

services based on the dscp priority.

untrust—— Trust port mode. In this mode, data will be classified into different
services based on the based on the port priority.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Set the trust mode of port 1/0/3 as dscp:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# qos trust mode dscp

252

28.2

qos port-priority
Description

The qos port-priority command is used to configure the port to 802.1p

priority mapping for the desired port. To return to the default configuration,

please use no qos port-priority command. When Port Priority is enabled, the

packets will be mapped to different priority queues based on the ingress

Syntax

ports.

qos port-priority { dot1p-priority }
no qos port-priority

Parameter

dot1p-priority —— The 802.1p priority that the packets will be mapped to
from the desired port. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represent 802.1p priority
0-7 respectively. By default, the priority is 0.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the priority of port 5 as 3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# qos port-priority 3

28.3

qos cos-map
Description

The qos cos-map command is used to configure 802.1p to queue mapping

globally. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos cos-map
command. When 802.1P Priority is enabled, the packets with 802.1Q tag are
mapped to different priority levels based on 802.1P priority.

253

Syntax

qos cos-map { dot1p-priority } { tc-queue }
no qos cos-map

Parameter

dot1p-priority —— The value of 802.1p priority. It ranges from 0 to 7, which
represent 802.1p priority 0-7 respectively.

tc-queue—— The number of TC queue that the 80.1p priority will be mapped
to. It ranges from 0 to 7.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Map the 802.1p priority 5 to TC-2:
T1600G-28TS (config)# qos cos-map 5 2

28.4

qos dot1p-remap
Description

The qos dot1p-remap command is used to configure the 802.1p to 802.1p

mappings. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos
dot1p-remap command. When 802.1p remap is configured, the packets with

Syntax

the specific 802.1p priority will tagged with the desired new 802.1p priority.
qos dot1p-remap { dot1p-priority } { new-dot1p-priority }
no qos dot1p-remap

Parameter

dot1p-priority —— The original 802.1p priority. It ranges from 0 to 7, which

represent 802.1p priority 0-7 respectively.

new-dot1p-priority—— The new 802.1p priority. It ranges from 0 to 7.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

254

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Remap 802.1p priority 5 to 802.1p priority 6:
T1600G-28TS(config)#qos dot1p-remap 5 6

28.5

qos dscp-map
Description

The qos dscp-map command is used to configure the DSCP to 802.1p

mapping. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos dscp-map
command. DSCP (DiffServ Code Point) is a new definition to IP ToS field given
by IEEE. This field is used to divide IP datagram into 64 priorities. When DSCP

Priority is enabled, IP datagram are mapped to different priority levels based

Syntax

on DSCP priority.

qos dscp-map { dscp-value-list } { dot1p-priority }
no qos dscp-map

Parameter

dscp-value-list —— The DSCP value list in the format of “1-3,5,7”. The valid

values are from 0 to 63.

dot1p-priority ——The 802.1p priority to which the DSCP priority will be
mapped. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represent 802.1p priority 0-7
respectively. By default, the priority is 0.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

255

Example

Map DSCP Priority 5 to 802.1p priority 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#qos dscp-map 5 2

28.6

qos dscp-remap
Description

The qos dscp-remap command is used to configure the DSCP to DSCP

mappings. To return to the default configuration, please use no qos
dscp-remap command. When DSCP remap is configured, the packets with

Syntax

the specific DSCP priority will be changed to the desired new DSCP priority.
qos queue dscp-map { dscp-value-list } { dscp-remap-value }
no qos queue dscp-map

Parameter

Dscp-value-list ——The original DSCP value list in the format of “1-3,5,7”. The
valid values are from 0 to 63.

Dscp-remap-value—— The new DSCP value, which ranges from 0 to 63.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Map DSCP values 10-12 to DSCP value 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# qos dscp-remap 10-12 2

28.7

qos queue mode
Description

The qos queue mode command is used to configure the Scheduler Mode.

When the network is congested, the program that many packets complete for

resources must be solved, usually in the way of queue scheduling. The switch

will control the forwarding sequence of the packets according to the priority

256

queues and scheduling algorithms you set. On this switch, the priority levels

Syntax

are labeled as TC0, TC1, TC2 … TC7.

qos queue { tc-queue } mode { sp | wrr } [ weight weight ]

Parameter

tc-queue —— The egress queue ID. It ranges from 0 to 7, which represents
TC queue from TC0 to TC7 respectively.

sp —— Strict-Priority Mode. In this mode, the queue with higher priority will
occupy the whole bandwidth. Packets in the queue with lower priority are sent
only when the queue with higher priority is empty.

wrr —— Weight Round Robin Mode. In this mode, packets in all the queues
are sent in order based on the weight value for each queue. If you select this
mode, you need to specify the queue weight at the same time.

weight —— Configure the weight value of the specified TC queue. When the

scheduler mode is specified as WRR, the weight value ranges from 1 to 127.
The 8 queues will take up the bandwidth according to their ratio.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the Scheduler Mode of TC1 as WRR and set the queue weight as 10
for port 1/0/1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# qos queue 1 mode wrr weight 10

28.8

show qos cos-map
Description

The show qos cos-msp command is used to display the 802.1p priority to TC

Syntax

queue mappings.

show qos cos-map
257

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the 802.1p to queue mappings:
T1600G-28TS# show qos cos-map

28.9

show qos dot1p-remap
Description

The show qos dot1p-remap interface command is used to display the

Syntax

802.1p priority to 802.1p priority mappings.
show qos dot1p-remap

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the IEEE 802.1P remap configuration:
T1600G-28TS# show qos dot1p-remap

28.10 show qos dscp-map
Description

The show qos dscp-map interface command is used to display the DSCP

Syntax

priority configuration.
show qos dscp-map

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

258

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the DSCP priority configuration:
T1600G-28TS# show qos dscp-map

28.11 show qos dscp-remap
Description

The show qos dscp-remap interface command is used to display the DSCP

Syntax

priority to DSCP priority mappingss.
show qos dscp-remap

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the DSCP to DSCP mappings:
T1600G-28TS# show qos dscp-remap

28.12 show qos port-priority interface
Description

The show qos port-priority interface command is used to display the port to

Syntax

802.1p priority mappings for the ports.

show qos port-priority interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |

ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
259

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the port to 802.1p priority mappings for all the ports:
T1600G-28TS# show qos port-priority interface

28.13 show qos trust interface
Description

The show qos trust interface command is used to display the trust mode of

Syntax

the ports.

show qos trust interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameter

port —— The port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the trust mode of all the ports:
T1600G-28TS# show qos trust interface

28.14 show qos queue interface
Description

The show qos queue interface command is used to display the scheduler

Syntax

settings of the ports.

show qos queue interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

260

Parameter

port —— The port number.

port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the scheduler settings of all the ports:
T1600G-28TS# show qos queue interface

261

Chapter 29 Bandwidth Control Commands
Bandwidth Control functions to control the traffic rate and traffic threshold on each port to

ensure network performance. Rate limit functions to limit the ingress/egress traffic rate on
each port. Storm Control function allows the switch to monitor broadcast packets, multicast
packets and Unknown unicast frames in the network.

29.1

storm-control rate-mode
Description

The storm-control rate-mode command is used to configure the storm

control mode of the interface. To return to the default configuration, please

Syntax

use no storm-control rate-mode command.
storm-control rate-mode { kbps | ratio }

no storm-control rate-mode

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

User Guidelines

This command should be used along with the storm-control command to
enable the storm control function and specify the detailed parameters.

Example

Set the storm control mode as kbps on port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control rate-mode kbps

29.2

storm-control
Description

The storm-control command is used to enable the broadcast, multicast, or
unknown unicast strom control function and to set threshold levels on an
262

interface. To return to the default configuration, please use no storm-control

Syntax

command.

storm-control { broadcast | multicast | unicast } { rate }

no storm-control { broadcast | multicast | unicast }

Parameter

broadcast | multicast | unicast —— Select the mode of the storm control on
the interface.

rate —— Specify the bandwidth for receiving packets on the port. The

specified type of packet traffic exceeding the bandwidth will be processed
according to the configuration of storm-control exceed command. For kbps,

the rate ranges from 1 to 1000000 kbps. For ratio, the rate ranges from 1 to
100 percent.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

User Guidelines

Before you configure the storm-control type as kbps or ratio, pelease ensure

that the port is not in pps mode.

Example

Configure the broadcast storm control rate as 1024 kbps on port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control rate-mode kbps
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control broadcast 1024

29.3

storm-control exceed
Description

The storm-control exceed command is used to configure the action that the

Syntax

switch will perform when the storm exceeds the defined limit on an interface.
storm-control exceed { drop | shutdown } [ revocer-time time ]
263

Parameter

drop —— Set the Action as Drop. The port will drop the subsequent packets
when the traffic exceeds the limit.

shutdown —— Set the Action as Shutdown. The port will be shutdown when
the traffic exceeds the limit.

time ——Specify the recover time for the port. It takes effect only when the

action is set as shutdown. The valid values are from 0 to 3600 and the default
value is 0. When the port is shutdown, it can recover to its normal state after
the recover time passed. If the recover time is specified as 0, which means

the port will not recover to its normal state automatically and you can recover
the port manually using storm-control recover command.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the action as drop on port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control exceed drop

29.4

storm-control recover
Description

The storm-control recover command is used to recover the port manually

after the port is shutdown because of the storm. When the recover time is

specified as 0, the port will not recover to its normal state automatically. In

Syntax

this condition, you need to use this command to recover the port manually.
storm-control recover

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

264

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Recover port 1/0/5 manually:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# storm-control recover

29.5

bandwidth
Description

The bandwidth command is used to configure the bandwidth limit for an
Ethernet port. To disable the bandwidth limit, please use no bandwidth

Syntax

command.

bandwidth {[ ingress ingress-rate ] [ egress egress-rate ]}
no bandwidth { all | ingress | egress }

Parameter

ingress-rate —— Specify the bandwidth for receiving packets. Range:

1-1000000Kbps for the gigaport.

egress-rate —— Specify the bandwidth for sending packets. Range:
1-1000000Kbps for the gigaport.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure the ingress-rate as 5120Kbps and egress-rate as 1024Kbps for

port 1/0/5:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# bandwidth ingress 5120 egress 1024

265

29.6

show storm-control
Description

The show storm-control command is used to display the storm-control

Syntax

information of Ethernet ports.

show storm-control interface [ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port-list
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id-list ]

Parameter

port-list ——The list of Ethernet ports.

port-channel-id-list —— The list of port channels.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the storm-control information of port 4, 5, 6, and 7:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show storm-control interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/4-7

29.7

show bandwidth
Description

The show bandwidth command is used to display the bandwidth-limit

Syntax

information of Ethernet ports.

show bandwidth interface [ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port-list
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id-list ]

Parameter

port-list ——The list of Ethernet ports.

port-channel-id-list —— The list of port channels.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

266

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the bandwidth-limit information of port 1/0/4:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show bandwidth interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/4

267

Chapter 30 Voice VLAN Commands
Voice VLANs are configured specially for voice data stream. By configuring Voice VLANs and
adding the ports with voice devices attached to voice VLANs, you can perform QoS-related

configuration for voice data, ensuring the transmission priority of voice data stream and voice
quality.

30.1

voice vlan
Description
The voice vlan command is used to enable Voice VLAN function. To disable
Voice VLAN function, please use no voice vlan command.

Syntax
voice vlan vlan-id
no voice vlan

Parameter
vlan-id —— Specify IEEE 802.1Q VLAN ID, ranging from 2 to 4094.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the Voice VLAN function for VLAN 10:
T1600G-28TS(config)# voice vlan 10

30.2

voice vlan (interface)
Description
The voice vlan command is used to enable Voice VLAN function on the

desired ports. To disable Voice VLAN function on ports, please use no voice
vlan command.

268

Syntax
voice vlan
no voice vlan

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the Voice VLAN function for port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#voice vlan

30.3

voice vlan priority
Description
The voice vlan priority command is used to configure the priority for the

Voice VLAN. To restore to the default priority, please use no voice vlan
priority command.

Syntax
voice vlan priority pri

no voice vlan priority

Parameter
pri —— Priority, ranging from 0 to 7, and the default value is 7.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

269

Example
Configure the priority of the Voice VLAN as 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# voice vlan priority 5

30.4

voice vlan oui
Description
The voice vlan oui command is used to create Voice VLAN OUI. To delete the
specified Voice VLAN OUI, please use no voice vlan oui command.

Syntax
voice vlan oui oui-prefix oui-desc string
no voice vlan mac-address oui-prefix

Parameter
oui-prefix —— The OUI address of the voice device, in the format of
XX:XX:XX.

string —— Give a description to the OUI for identification which contains 16

characters at most.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create a Voice VLAN OUI described as TP-Phone with the OUI address

00:11:11:11:11:11 and the mask address FF:FF:FF:00:00:00:

T1600G-28TS(config)#voice vlan oui 00:11:11 oui-desc TP-Phone

30.5

show voice vlan
Description
The show voice vlan command is used to display the global configuration
information of Voice VLAN.

270

Syntax
show voice vlan

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Display the configuration information of Voice VLAN globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show voice vlan

30.6

show voice vlan oui-table
Description
The show voice vlan oui command is used to display the configuration
information of Voice VLAN OUI.

Syntax
show voice vlan oui

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Display the configuration information of Voice VLAN OUI:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show voice vlan oui-table

30.7

show voice vlan interface
Description
The show voice vlan interface command is used to display the Voice VLAN

configuration information of all ports.
271

Syntax
show voice vlan interface

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Display the Voice VLAN configuration information of all ports and port
channels:

T1600G-28TS(config)# show voice vlan interface

272

Chapter 31 Auto VoIP Commands
The Auto VoIP feature is used to prioritize the transmission of voice traffic. Voice over Internet
Protocol (VoIP) enables telephone calls over a data network, and the Auto VoIP feature helps
provide a classification mechanism for voice packets. When Auto VoIP is configured on a port
that receives both voice and data traffic, this feature can help ensure that the sound quality of
an IP phone does not deteriorate when data traffic on the port is heavy.

31.1 auto-voip
Description
The auto-voip command is used to enable the Auto VoIP function globally.
To disable the Auto VoIP function, use no auto-voip command.

Syntax
auto-voip
no auto-voip

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Example
Enable the Auto VoIP function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# auto-voip

31.2 auto-voip (interface)
Description
The auto-voip command is used to specify the interface mode as VLAN ID

for the ports. In this mode, the voice devices will send voice packets with

desired VLAN tag.

Syntax
auto-voip vlan-id

Parameter
vlan-id ——Specify the Auto VoIP VLAN ID. The valid values are from 2 to

4094.

273

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Set Auto VoIP VLAN 3 for port 3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip 3

31.3 auto-voip dot1p
Description
The auto-voip dot1p command is used to specify the interface mode as

dat1p for the ports. In this mode, the voice devices will send voice packets

with desired 802.1p priority.

Syntax
auto-voip dot1p dot1p

Parameter
dot1p——Set the 802.1p priority of Auto VoIP on specified ports. It ranges
from 0 to 7.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Set the 802.1p priority as 5 for the port:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip dot1p 5

274

31.4 auto-voip untagged
Description
The auto-voip untagged command is used to specify the interface mode as

untagged for the ports. In this mode, the voice devices will send untagged
voice packets.

Syntax
auto-voip untagged

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Set the interface mode as untagged for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip untagged

31.5 auto-voip none
Description
The auto-voip none command is used to specify the interface mode as none

for the ports. In this mode, the switch allows the voice devices to use its own

configuration to send voice traffic.

Syntax
auto-voip none

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Instruct voice devices that are connected to port 3 to send the packets
according to its own configuration:

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip none
275

31.6 no auto-voip (interface)
Description
The no auto-voip command is used to specify the interface mode as

disabled for the ports, which means the Auto VoIP function is disabled on the
corresponding port.

Syntax
no auto-voip

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Disable the Auto VoIP function on port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# no auto-voip

31.7 auto-voip dscp
Description
The auto-voip dscp command is used to set the DSCP value of Auto VoIP on

specified ports.

Syntax
auto-voip dscp value

Parameter
value——Set the DSCP value of Auto VoIP on specified ports. It ranges from
0 to 63. By default, it is 0.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Set DSCP value of Auto VoIP on port 3 as 33:
276

T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip dscp 33

31.8 auto-voip data priority
Description
The auto-voip data priority command is used to enable or disable the CoS
Override Mode on specified ports.

Syntax
auto-voip data priority { trust | untrust }

Parameter
trust——In this mode, the switch will then put the voice packets in the
corresponding TC queue according to the 802.1p priority of the packets.

untrust——In this mode, the switch will ignore the 802.1p priority in the voice
packets and put the packets in TC-5 directly.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Set the CoS Override Mode as trust for port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# auto-voip data priority trust

31.9 show auto-voip
Description
The show auto-voip command is used to display the Auto VoIP configuration
information.

Syntax
show auto-voip [ interface ]

277

Parameter
interface —— Displays the Auto VoIP configuration information of ports.
When no parameter is entered, displays the global Auto VoIP configuration
information.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and any Configuration Mode

Example
Displays the global Auto VoIP configuration information:
T1600G-28TS (config)# show auto-voip

278

Chapter 32 Access Control Commands
32.1

user access-control ip-based enable
Description
The user access-control ip-based enable command is used to configure the

access control mode IP-based. To disable the access control feature, please

use no user access-control command.

Syntax
user access-control ip-based enable
no user access-control

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the access control mode as IP-based:
T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control ip-based enable

32.2

user access-control ip-based
Description
The user access-control ip-based command is used to limit the IP-range of

the users for login. Only the users within the IP-range you set here are

allowed to login. You can add up to 30 IP-based entries. To cancel the user
access limit, please use no user access-control ip-based command.

Syntax
user access-control ip-based { ip-addr ip-mask } [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ]

[ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ]

no user access-control ip-based index id

279

Parameter
ip-addr —— The source IP address. Only the users within the IP-range you
set here are allowed for login. 5 IP-based entries can be configured at most.

ip-mask —— The subnet mask of the IP address.

[ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] —— Specify the access
interface. These interfaces are enabled by default.

id —— Delete the specified IP-based entry.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable the access-control of the user whose IP address is 192.168.0.148:
T1600G-28TS(config)#

user

access-control

ip-based

192.168.0.148

255.255.255.255

32.3

user access-control mac-based enable
Description
The user access-control mac-based enable command is used to configure

the access control mode MAC-based. To disable the access control feature,
please use no user access-control command.

Syntax
user access-control mac-based enable
no user access-control

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

280

Example
Configure the access control mode as MAC-based:
T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control mac-based enable

32.4

user access-control mac-based
Description
The user access-control mac-based command is used to limit the MAC

address of the users for login. Only the user with this MAC address you set

here is allowed to login. You can add up to 30 mac-based control entries. To

delete the mac-based access control entry, please use no user

access-control mac-based command.

Syntax
user access-control mac-based { mac-addr } [ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ]
[ https ] [ ping ] [ all ]

no user access-control mac-based index id

Parameter
mac-addr —— The source MAC address. Only the user with this MAC
address is allowed to login.

[ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] —— Specify the access
interface. These interfaces are enabled by default.

id—— Specify the ID of the mac-based entry to be deleted.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure that only the user whose MAC address is 00:00:13:0A:00:01 is
allowed to login:

T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control mac-based 00:00:13:0A:00:01

281

32.5

user access-control port-based enable
Description
The user access-control port-based enable command is used to configure
the access control mode Port-based. To disable the access control feature,
please use no user access-control command.

Syntax
user access-control port-based enable
no user access-control

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the access control mode as Port-based:
T1600G-28TS(config)# user access-control port-based enable

32.6

user access-control port-based
Description
The user access-control port-based command is used to limit the ports for

login. Only the users connected to these ports you set here are allowed to

login. You can add up to 30 port-based control entries. To delete the

port-based access control entry, please use no user access-control

port-based command.

Syntax
user access-control port-based interface { gigabitEthernet port-list } [ snmp ]

[ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ]

no user access-control port-based index id

Parameter
port-list ——The list group of Ethernet ports, in the format of 1/0/1-4. You can
appoint 5 ports at most.

282

[ snmp ] [ telnet ] [ ssh ] [ http ] [ https ] [ ping ] [ all ] —— Specify the access
interface. These interfaces are enabled by default.

id—— Specify the ID of the port-based entry to be deleted.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure that only the users connected to ports 2-6 are allowed to login:
T1600G-28TS(config)#

user

gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-6

283

access-control

port-based

interface

Chapter 33 HTTP and HTTPS Commands
With the help of HTTP (HyperText Transfer Protocol) or HTTPS (Hyper Text Transfer Protocol
over Secure Socket Layer), you can manage the switch through a standard browser.
HTTP is the protocol to exchange or transfer hypertext.

SSL (Secure Sockets Layer), a security protocol, is to provide a secure connection for the
application layer protocol (e.g. HTTP) based on TCP. Adopting asymmetrical encryption

technology, SSL uses key pair to encrypt/decrypt information. A key pair refers to a public key
(contained in the certificate) and its corresponding private key. By default the switch has a
certificate (self-signed certificate) and a corresponding private key. The Certificate/Key
Download function enables the user to replace the default key pair.

33.1

ip http server
Description
The ip http server command is used to enable the HTTP server within the
switch. To disable the HTTP function, please use no ip http server command.

This function is enabled by default. The HTTP and HTTPS server function
cannot be disabled at the same time.

Syntax
ip http server
no ip http server

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Disable the HTTP function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no ip http server

33.2

ip http port
Description
284

The ip http port command is used to configure the port number of the HTTP
server within the switch. To set the number to the default value, please use no
ip http port command.

Syntax
ip http port port-num
no ip http port

Parameter
port-num —— Enter the port number. This value ranges from 1 to 65535.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Set the port number of HTTP server as 1800:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http port 1800

33.3

ip http max-users
Description

The ip http max-users command is used to configure the maximum number

of users that are allowed to connect to the HTTP server. To cancel this
limitation, please use no ip http max-users command.

Syntax
ip http max-users admin-num operator-num poweruser-num user-num
no ip http max-users

Parameter
admin-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP

server as Admin, ranging from 1 to 16. The total number of users should be

no more than 16.

operator-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the
HTTP server as operator, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users
should be no more than 16.

285

poweruser-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the
HTTP server as Power User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users

should be no more than 16.

user-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP

server as User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be no

more than 16.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the maximum number of the Admin, Operator, Power User and
User as 5, 1, 1, 1 for HTTP:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http max-users 5 1 1 1

33.4

ip http session timeout
Description
The ip http session timeout command is used to configure the connection
timeout of the HTTP server. To restore to the default timeout time, please use
no ip http session timeout command.

Syntax
ip http session timeout time
no ip http session timeout

Parameter
time ——The timeout time, ranging from 5 to 30 in minutes. By default, the
value is 10.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
286

Configure the timeout time of the HTTP connection as 15 minutes:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http session timeout 15

33.5

ip http secure-server
Description

The ip http secure-server command is used to enable the HTTPS server

within the switch. To disable the HTTPS function, please use no ip http
secure-server command. This function is enabled by default. The HTTP and
HTTPS server function cannot be disabled at the same time.

Syntax
ip http secure-server
no ip http secure-server

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Disable the HTTP function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no ip http secure-server

33.6

ip http secure-port
Description
The ip http secure-port command is used to configure the port number of

the HTTPS server within the switch. To set the number to the default value,
please use no ip http secure-port command.

Syntax
ip http secure-port port-num
no ip http secure-port

Parameter
port-num —— Enter the port number. This value ranges from 1 to 65535.
287

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Set the port number of HTTPS server as 2800:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http port 2800

33.7

ip http secure-protocol
Description
The ip http secure-protocol command is used to configure the SSL protocol
version. To restore to the default SSL version, please use no ip http
secure-protocol command. By default, the switch supports SSLv3 and

TLSv1.

Syntax
ip http secure-protocol { [ ssl3 ] [ tls1 ] }
no ip http session

Parameter
ssl3 —— The SSL 3.0 protocol.
tls1 —— The TLS 1.0 protocol

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the protocol of SSL connection as SSL 3.0:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-protocol ssl3

288

33.8

ip http secure-ciphersuite
Description
The ip http secure-ciphersuite command is used to configure the

cipherSuites over the SSL connection supported by the switch. To restore to

the default ciphersuite types, please use no ip http secure-ciphersuite
command.

Syntax
ip http secure-ciphersuite { [ 3des-ede-cbc-sha ] [ rc4-128-md5 ]

[ rc4-128-sha ] [ des-cbc-sha ] }
no ip http secure-ciphersuite

Parameter
[ 3des-ede-cbc-sha ] [ rc4-128-md5 ] [ rc4-128-sha ] [ des-cbc-sha ] ——

Specify the encryption algorithm and the digest algorithm to use on an SSL
connection. By default, the switch supports all these ciphersuites.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the ciphersuite to be used for encryption over the SSL connection

as 3des-ede-cbc-sha:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-ciphersuite 3des-ede-cbc-sha

33.9

ip http secure-max-users
Description

The ip http secure-max-users command is used to configure the maximum

number of users that are allowed to connect to the HTTPs server. To cancel
this limitation, please use no ip http secure-max-users command.

Syntax

289

ip http secure-max-users admin-num operator-num poweruser-num

user-num

no ip secure-max-users

Parameter
admin-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTPs

server as Admin, ranging from 1 to 16. The total number of users should be
less than 16.

Operator-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the
HTTPs server as operator, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users

should be less than 16.

poweruser-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the
HTTP server as Power User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users

should be less than 16.

user-num —— The maximum number of the users logging on to the HTTP
server as User, ranging from 0 to 15. The total number of users should be less

than 16.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum number of the Admin, Operator, Power User and
User as 5, 1, 1, 1 for HTTPs:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-max-users 5 1 1 1

33.10 ip http secure-session timeout
Description
The ip http secure-session timeout command is used to configure the

connection timeout of the HTTPS server. To restore to the default timeout
time, please use no ip http secure-session timeout command.

Syntax
ip http secure-session timeout time
290

no ip http secure-session timeout

Parameter
time —— The timeout time, ranging from 5 to 30 in minutes. By default, the

value is 10.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the timeout time of the HTTPs connection as 15 minutes:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-session timeout 15

33.11 ip http secure-server download certificate
Description
The ip http secure-server download certificate command is used to

download a certificate to the switch from TFTP server.

Syntax
ip http secure-server download certificate ssl-cert ip-address ip-addr

Parameter

ssl-cert —— The name of the SSL certificate which is selected to download

to the switch. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 25 characters. The
Certificate must be BASE64 encoded.

ip-addr —— The IP address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
291

Download an SSL Certificate named ssl-cert from TFTP server with the IP

address of 192.168.0.146:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download certificate ssl-cert
ip-address 192.168.0.146
Download an SSL Certificate named ssl-cert from TFTP server with the IP

address of fe80::1234

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download certificate ssl-cert
ip-address fe80::1234

33.12

ip http secure-server download key

Description
The ip http secure-server download key command is used to download an
SSL key to the switch from TFTP server.

Syntax
ip http secure-server download key ssl-key ip-address ip-addr

Parameter

ssl-key —— The name of the SSL key which is selected to download to the

switch. The length of the name ranges from 1 to 25 characters. The Key must
be BASE64 encoded.

ip-addr —— The IP address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Download an SSL key named ssl-key from TFTP server with the IP address of
192.168.0.146:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download key ssl-key
ip-address 192.168.0.146
292

Download an SSL key named ssl-key from TFTP server with the IP address of
fe80::1234

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http secure-server download key ssl-key
ip-address fe80::1234

33.13 show ip http configuration
Description
The show ip http configuration command is used to display the
configuration information of the HTTP server, including status, session
timeout, access-control, max-user number and the idle-timeout, etc.

Syntax
show ip http configuration

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration information of the HTTP server:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip http configuration

33.14 show ip http secure-server
Description
The show ip http secure-server command is used to display the global
configuration of SSL.

Syntax
show ip http secure-server

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.
293

Example
Display the global configuration of SSL:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip http secure-server

294

Chapter 34 SSH Commands
SSH (Security Shell) can provide the unsecured remote management with security and
powerful authentication to ensure the security of the management information.

34.1

ip ssh server
Description
The ip ssh server command is used to enable SSH function. To disable the
SSH function, please use no ip ssh server command.

Syntax
ip ssh server
no ip ssh server

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the SSH function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh server

34.2

ip ssh port
Description
The ip ssh port command is used to configure the port for SSH service. To
set the value to the default, please use no ip ssh port command.

Syntax
ip ssh port port
no ip ssh port

295

Parameter
port —— Set the port number. It ranges from 1 to 65535. The default value is
22.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the SSH port number as 22:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh port 22

34.3

ip ssh version
Description
The ip ssh version command is used to enable the SSH protocol version. To

disable the protocol version, please use no ip ssh version command.

Syntax
ip ssh version { v1 | v2 }
no ip ssh version { v1 | v2 }

Parameter
v1 | v2 —— The SSH protocol version to be enabled. They
represent SSH v1 and SSH v2 respectively.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Enable SSH v2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh version v2

296

34.4

ip ssh algorithm
Description

The ip ssh algorithm command is used to configure the algorithm in SSH
function. To disable the specified algorithm, please use no ip ssh algorithm

Syntax

command.

ip ssh algorithm { AES128-CBC | AES192-CBC | AES256-CBC | Blowfish-CBC

| Cast128-CBC | 3DES-CBC | HMAC-SHA1 | HMAC-MD5 }
no ip ssh algorithm

Parameter

AES128-CBC | AES192-CBC | AES256-CBC | Blowfish-CBC |

Cast128-CBC | 3DES-CBC | HMAC-SHA1 | HMAC-MD5 ——
Specify the SSH algorithm.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the SSH algorithm as AES128-CBC:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh algorithm AES128-CBC

34.5

ip ssh timeout
Description
The ip ssh timeout command is used to specify the idle-timeout time of SSH.
To restore to the factory defaults, please use ip ssh timeout command.

Syntax
ip ssh timeout value
no ip ssh timeout

Parameter
value —— The Idle-timeout time. During this period, the system
will automatically release the connection if there is no
297

operation from the client. It ranges from 1 to 120 in seconds.
By default, this value is 120 seconds.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the idle-timeout time of SSH as 30 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh timeout 30

34.6

ip ssh max-client
Description
The ip ssh max-client command is used to specify the maximum number of
the connections to the SSH server. To return to the default configuration,
please use no ip ssh max-client command.

Syntax
ip ssh max-client num
no ip ssh max-client

Parameter
num —— The maximum number of the connections to the SSH server. It
ranges from 1 to 5. By default, this value is 5.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Specify the maximum number of the connections to the SSH server as 3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh max-client 3

298

34.7

ip ssh download
Description
The ip ssh download command is used to download the SSH key file from

Syntax

TFTP server.

ip ssh download { v1 | v2 } key-file ip-address ip-addr

Parameter

v1 | v2 —— Select the type of SSH key to download, v1 represents SSH-1,
v2 represents SSH-2.

key-file —— The name of the key-file which is selected to download. The
length of the name ranges from 1 to 25 characters. The key length of the

downloaded file must be in the range of 512 to 3072 bits.

ip-addr —— The IP address of the TFTP server. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
are supported, for example 192.168.0.1 or fe80::1234.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Download an SSH-1 type key file named ssh-key from TFTP server with the IP

address 192.168.0.148:

T1600G-28TS(config)#

ip

ssh

download

v1

ssh-key

ip-address

192.168.0.148
Download an SSH-1 type key file named ssh-key from TFTP server with the IP

address fe80::1234:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip ssh download v1 ssh-key ip-address fe80::1234

34.8

remove public-key
Description

The remove public-key command is used to remove the SSH public key from
the switch.

299

Syntax

remove public-key { v1 | v2 }

Parameter

v1 | v2 —— Select the type of SSH public key, v1 represents SSH-1, v2

represents SSH-2.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Remove the SSH-1 type public key from the switch:
T1600G-28TS# remove public-key v1

34.9

show ip ssh
Description
Syntax

The show ip ssh command is used to display the global configuration of SSH.
show ip ssh

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the global configuration of SSH:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show ip ssh

300

Chapter 35 Telnet Commands
35.1

telnet enable
Description

The telnet enable command is used to enable the Telnet function. To disable

the Telnet function, please use the telnet disable command. This function is

enabled by default.

Syntax
telnet enable
telnet disable

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Disable the Telnet function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# telnet disable

35.2

telnet port
Description

The telnet port command is used to configure the telent port number. To
restore the setting, please use the no telnet port command.

Syntax
telnet port port
no telnet port

Parameter
port——The number of telnet port.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode
301

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the telnet port number as 566:
T1600G-28TS(config)# telnet port 566

35.3

show telnet-status
Description
The show telnet-status command is used to display the configuration
information of the Telnet function.

Syntax
show telnet-status

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display whether the Telnet function is enabled:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show telnet-status

302

Chapter 36 AAA Commands
AAA stands for authentication, authorization and accounting. This feature is used to
authenticate users trying to log in to the switch or trying to access the administrative level
privilege.


Applicable Access Application

The authentication can be applied on the following access applications: Telnet, SSH and HTTP.


Authentication Method List

A method list describes the authentication methods and their sequence to authenticate a user.
The switch supports Login List for users to gain access to the switch, and Enable List for
normal users to gain administrative privileges.


RADIUS/TACACS+ Server

User can configure the RADIUS/TACACS+ servers for the connection between the switch and
the server.


Server Group

User can define the authentication server group with up to several servers running the same
secure protocols, either RADIUS or TACACS+. Users can set these servers in a preferable
order, which is called the server group list. When a user tries to access the switch, the switch
will ask the first server in the server group list for authentication. If no response is received, the
second server will be queried, and so on.

36.1

tacacas-server host
Description
The tacacs-server host command is used to configure a new TACACS+

server. To delete the specified TACACS+ server, please use no
tacacs-server host command.

Syntax
tacacs-server host ip-address [ port port-id ] [ timeout time ] [ key { [ 0 ]

string | 7 encryped-string } ]

no tacacs-server host ip-address

Parameter
ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the TACACS+ server.

port-id —— Specify the server’s port number for AAA. By default it is 49.

303

time —— Specify the time in seconds the switch waits for the server’s

response before it times out. The time ranges from 1 to 9 seconds. The
default is 5 seconds.

[ 0 ] string | 7 encrypted-string —— 0 and 7 are the encryption type. 0

indicates that an unencrypted key will follow. 7 indicates that a symmetric

encrypted key with a fixed length will follow. By default, the encryption type is
0. “string” is the shared key for the switch and the authentication servers to

exchange messages which contains 32 characters at most. The question

marks and spaces are not allowed. “encrypted-string” is a symmetric
encrypted key with a fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s
configuration file. The key or encrypted-key you configured here will be

displayed in the encrypted form. Always configure the key as the last item of

this command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

The TACACS+ servers you configured are added in the server group “tacacs”
by default.

Example
Configure a TACACS+ server with the IP address as 1.1.1.1, TCP port as 1500,
timeout as 6 seconds, and the unencrypted key string as 12345.

T1600G-28TS(config)# tacacs-server host 1.1.1.1 port 1500 timeout 6 key
12345

36.2

show tacacs-server
Description
This show tacacs-server command is used to display the summary

information of the TACACS+ servers.

Syntax
show tacacs-server

304

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the information of all the TACACS+ servers:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show tacacs-server

36.3

radius-server host
Description
The radius-server host command is used to configure a new RADIUS server.

To delete the specified RADIUS server, please use no radius-server host

command.

Syntax
radius-server host ip-address [ auth-port port-id ] [ acct-port port-id ]
[ timeout time ] [ retransmit number ] [ nas-id nas-id ]

encrypted-string } ]

[ key { [ 0 ] string | 7

no radius-server host ip-address

Parameter
ip-address —— Specify the IP address of the RADIUS server.

auth-port port-id —— Specify the UDP destination port for authentication
requests. By default it is 1812.

acct-port port-id —— Specify the UDP destination port for accouting
requests. By deault it is 1813.

time —— Specify the time in seconds the switch waits for the server’s

response before it times out. The time ranges from 1 to 9 seconds. The
default is 5 seconds.

number —— Specify the number of times a RADIUS request is resent to a
server if the server is not responding in time. By default it is 2 times.

nas-id ——Specify the name of the NAS (Network Access Server) to be
contained in RADIUS packets for identification. It ranges from 1 to 31

characters. The default value is the MAC address of the switch. Generally, the

NAS indicates the switch itself.

305

[ 0 ] string | 7 encrypted-string —— 0 and 7 are the encryption type. 0

indicates that an unencrypted key will follow. 7 indicates that a symmetric

encrypted key with a fixed length will follow. By default, the encryption type is
0. “string” is the shared key for the switch and the authentication servers to

exchange messages which contains 32 characters at most. The question

marks and spaces are not allowed. “encrypted-string” is a symmetric
encrypted key with a fixed length, which you can copy from another switch’s

configuration file. The key or encrypted-key you configured here will be

displayed in the encrypted form. Always configure the key as the last item of

this command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

The RADIUS servers you configured are added in the server group “radius” by
default.

Example
Configure a RADIUS server with the IP address as 1.1.1.1, authentication port
as 1200, timeout as 6 seconds, retransmit times as 3, and the unencrypted
key string as 12345.

T1600G-28TS(config)# radius-server host 1.1.1.1 auth-port 1200 timeout
6 retransmit 3 key 12345

36.4

show radius-server
Description
This show radius-server command is used to display the summary

information of the RADIUS servers.

Syntax
show radius-server

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
306

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the information of all the RADIUS servers:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show radius-server

36.5

aaa group
Description
This aaa group command is used to create AAA server groups to group

existing TACACS+/RADIUS servers for authentication. This command puts
the switch in the server group subconfiguration mode.

To delete the corresponding AAA group, please use the no aaa group
command.

Syntax

aaa group { radius | tacacs } group-name

no aaa group { radius | tacacs } group-name

Parameter
radius | tacacs —— Specify the server group type as RADIUS or TACACS+.

group-name —— Specify the server group name.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Create a RADIUS server group with the name radius1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa group radius radius1

307

36.6

server
Description
This server command is used to add the existing server in the defined server

group. To remove the specified server from the server group, please use the
no server command.

Syntax

server ip-address

no server ip-address

Parameter
ip-address —— Specify the server’s IP address.

Command Mode
Server Group Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Create the RADIUS server 1.1.1.1 to RADIUS server group “radius1”:
T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa group radius radius1
T1600G-28TS(aaa-group)# server 1.1.1.1

36.7

show aaa group
Description
This show aaa group command is used to display the summary information

of the AAA groups. All the servers in this group will be listed if you specify the

group name.

Syntax
show aaa group [ group-name ]

Parameter
group-name —— Specify the server group name.

308

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the information of all the server groups:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa group

36.8

aaa authentication login
Description
This aaa authentication login command is used to configure a login
authentication method list. A method list describes the authentication

methods and their sequence to authenticate a user. To delete the specified

authentication method list, please use the no aaa authentication login
command.

Syntax
aaa authentication login { method-list } { method1 } [ method2 ] [ method3 ]
[ method4 ]

no authentication login method-list

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the method list name.

method1, method2, method3, method4 —— Specify the authentication

methods in order. The next authentication method is tried only if the previous
method does not respond, not if it fails.

The preset methods include radius, tacacs, local and none. “radius” means
the RADIUS server group “radius”; “tacacs” means the RACACS+ server

group “tacacs”; “local” means local username database are used; “none”
means no authentication is used for login.

Users can aslo define new method with the aaa group command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

309

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

By default the login authentication method list is “default” with “local” as
method1.

Example
Configure a login authentication method list “list1” with the priority1 method
as radius and priority2 method as local:

T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa authenticaiton login list1 radius local

36.9

aaa authentication enable
Description
This aaa authentication enable command is used to configure a privilege

authentication method list. A method list describes the authentication
methods and their sequence to elevate a user’s privilege. To delete the

specified authentication method list, please use the no aaa authentication
enable command.

Syntax
aaa authentication enable { method-list } { method1 } [ method2 ] [ method3 ]
[ method4 ]

no authentication enable method-list

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the method list name.

method1, method2, method3, method4 —— Specify the authentication

methods in order. The next authentication method is tried only if the previous
method does not respond, not if it fails.

The preset methods include radius, tacacs, local and none. “radius” means
the RADIUS server group “radius”; “tacacs” means the RACACS+ server

group “tacacs”; “local” means local username database are used; “none”
means no authentication is used for privilege elevation.

Users can aslo define new method with the aaa group command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode
310

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

User Guidelines

By default the enable authentication method is “default” with “none” as
method1.

Example
Configure a privilege authentication method list “list2” with the priority1
method as radius and priority2 method as local:

T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa authenticaiton enable list2 radius local

36.10 aaa authentication dot1x default
Description
This aaa authentication dot1x default command is used to configure an
802.1x authentication method list. A method list describes the authentication
methods for users’ login in 802.1x. To delete the default authentication
method list, please use the no aaa authentication dot1x default command.

Syntax
aaa authentication dot1x default { method }
no aaa authentication dot1x default

Parameter
method —— Specify the method name. Only RADIUS server group is
supported, and the default method is server group “radius”.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the default 802.1x authentication method as “radius1”:

T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa authentication dot1x default radius1

311

36.11 aaa accounting dot1x default
Description
This aaa accounting dot1x default command is used to configure an 802.1x
accounting method list. To delete the default accounting method list, please
use the no aaa accounting dot1x default command.

Syntax
aaa accounting dot1x default { method }
no aaa accounting dot1x default

Parameter
method —— Sp+ecify the method name. Only RADIUS server group is
supported, and the default method is server group “radius”.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the default 802.1x accounting method as “radius1”:

T1600G-28TS(config)# aaa accounting dot1x default radius1

36.12 show aaa authentication
Description
This show aaa authentication command is used to display the summary
information of the authentication login, enable and dot1x metheod list.

Syntax
show aaa authentication [ login | enable | dot1x ]

Parameter
login | enable | dot1x —— Specify the method list type.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
312

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the information of all the authentication method lists:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa authentication

36.13 show aaa accounting
Description
This show aaa accounting command is used to display the summary
information of the accounting metheod list.

Syntax
show aaa accounting [ dot1x ]

Parameter
dot1x —— Specify the method list type.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the information of the default 802.1x accounting method list:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa accounting

36.14 line telnet
Description
The line telnet command is used to enter the Line Configuration Mode to
configure the telnet terminal line to which you want to apply the
authentication list.

Syntax
line telnet

313

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enter the telnet terminal line configuration mode:
T1600G-28TS(config)#line telnet

36.15 login authentication (telnet)
Description
The login authentication command is used to apply the login authentication

method list to the telnet terminal line. To restore to the default authentication
method list, please use the no login authentication command.

Syntax
login authentication { method-list }
no login authentication

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the login method list on the telnet terminal line. It is
“default” by default, which contains the method “local”.

Command Mode
Line Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the login authentication method list on the telnet terminal line as

“list1”:

T1600G-28TS(config)#line telnet
T1600G-28TS(config-line)# login authentication list1

314

36.16 line ssh
Description
The line ssh command is used to enter the Line Configuration Mode to

configure the ssh terminal line to which you want to apply the authentication
list.

Syntax
line ssh

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enter the ssh terminal line configuration mode:
T1600G-28TS(config)#line ssh

36.17 login authentication (ssh)
Description
The login authentication command is used to apply the login authentication

method list to the ssh terminal line. To restore to the default authentication
method list, please use the no login authentication command.

Syntax
login authentication { method-list }
no login authentication

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the login method list on the ssh terminal line. It is

“default” by default, which contains the method “local”.

Command Mode
Line Configuration Mode

315

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the login authentication method list on the ssh terminal line as
“list1”:

T1600G-28TS(config)# line ssh
T1600G-28TS(config-line)# login authentication list1

36.18 enable authentication (telnet)
Description
The enable authentication command is used to apply the privilege
authentication method list to the telnet terminal line. To restore to the default

authentication method list, please use the no enable authentication

command.

Syntax
enable authentication { method-list }
no enable authentication

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the enable method list on the telnet terminal line. It is
“default” by default, which contains the method “none”.

Command Mode
Line Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the enable authentication method list on the telnet terminal line as
“list2”:

T1600G-28TS(config)#line telnet
T1600G-28TS(config-line)# enable authentication list2

316

36.19 enable authentication (ssh)
Description
The enable authentication command is used to apply the privilege
authentication method list to the ssh terminal line. To restore to the default

authentication method list, please use the no enable authentication
command.

Syntax
enable authentication { method-list }
no enable authentication

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the enable method list on the ssh terminal line. It is
“default” by default, which contains the method “none”.

Command Mode
Line Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the enable authentication method list on the ssh terminal line as
“list2”:

T1600G-28TS(config)# line ssh
T1600G-28TS(config-line)# enable authentication list2

36.20 ip http login authentication
Description
The ip http login authentication command is used to apply the login

authentication method list to users accessing through HTTP. To restore to
the default authentication method list, please use the no ip http login
authentication command.

Syntax
ip http login authentication { method-list }
317

no ip http login authentication

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the login method list on the HTTP access. It is

“default” by default, which contains the method “local”.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the login authentication method list on the HTTP access as “list1”:
T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http login authentication list1

36.21 ip http enable authentication
Description
The ip http enable authentication command is used to apply the privilege

authentication method list to users accessing through HTTP. To restore to
the default authentication method list, please use the no ip http enable
authentication command.

Syntax
ip http enable authentication { method-list }
no ip http enable authentication

Parameter
method-list —— Specify the enable method list on the HTTP access. It is

“default” by default, which contains the method “none”.

Command Mode
Line Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

318

Example
Configure the enable authentication method list on the HTTP access as
“list2”:

T1600G-28TS(config)# ip http enable authentication list2

36.22 show aaa global
Description
This show aaa global command is used to display global status of AAA

function and the login/enable method lists of different application modules:
telnet, ssh and HTTP.

Syntax
show aaa global

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example
Display the AAA function’s global status and each application’s method list:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show aaa global

36.23 enable-admin
Description
The enable-admin command is used to get the administrative privelges by a

non-admin user.

Syntax
enable-admin

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode

319

Privilege Requirement
Only User, Power User and Operator level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Get the administrative privelges (the Enable password is “123456”):
T1600G-28TS# enable-admin
Password: 123456

320

Chapter 37 IEEE 802.1x Commands
IEEE 802.1x function is to provide an access control for LAN ports via the authentication. An
802.1x system include three entities: supplicant, authenticator and authentication server.



Supplicant: the device that requests access to the LAN.

Authentication server: performs the actual authentication of the supplicant. It validates the

identity of the supplicant and notifies the authenticator whether or not the supplicant is
authorized to access the LAN.


Authenticator: controls the physical access to the network based on the authentication

status of the supplicant. It is usually an 802.1x-supported network device, such as this

TP-Link switch. It acts as an intermediary (proxy) between the supplicant and the

authentication server, requesting identity information from the supplicant, verifying that
information with the authentication server, and relaying a response to the supplicant.

This chapter handles with the authentication process between the supplicant and the switch.

To realize the authentication and accounting function, you should also enbable the AAA
function and configure the RADIUS server. Go to Chapter 42 AAA Commands for more details.

37.1

dot1x system-auth-control
Description
The dot1x system-auth-control command is used to enable the IEEE 802.1x

function globally. To disable the IEEE 802.1x function, please use no dot1x
system-auth-control command.

Syntax
dot1x system-auth-control
no dot1x system-auth-control

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the IEEE 802.1x function:
T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x system-auth-control
321

37.2

dot1x handshake
Description
The dot1x handshake command is used enable the handshake feature. The

handshake feature is used to detect the connection status between the

TP-Link 802.1x supplicant and the switch. Please disable the handshake

feature if you are using a non-TP-Link 802.1x-compliant client software. This
feature is enabled by default.

Syntax
dot1x handshake
no dot1x handshake

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Disable the 802.1x handshake function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no dot1x handshake

37.3

dot1x auth-protocol
Description
The dot1x auth-protocol command is used to configure the authentication

protocol of IEEE 802.1x and the default 802.1x authentication method is “eap”.
To restore to the default 802.1x authentication protocol, please use no dot1x

auth-protocol command.

Syntax
dot1x auth-protocol { pap | eap }
no dot1x auth-protocol

Parameter
pap | eap ——Authentication protocols.

322

pap: EAP termination mode. IEEE 802.1x authentication system uses

extensible authentication protocol (EAP) to exchange information between

the switch and the client. The EAP packets are terminated at the switch and
repackaged in the Password Authentication Protocol (PAP) packets, and then
transferred to the RADIUS server.

eap: EAP relay mode. IEEE 802.1x authentication system uses extensible
authentication protocol (EAP) to exchange information between the switch

and the client. The EAP protocol packets with authentication data are

encapsulated in the advanced protocol (such as RADIUS) packets and
transmitted to the authentication server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the Authentication protocol of IEEE 802.1x as “pap”:
T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x auth-protocol pap

37.4

dot1x vlan-assignment
Description
The dot1x vlan-assignment command is used to enable the VLAN
assignment

feature.To

disable this

vlan-assignment command.

feature,

please use no dot1x

802.1x VLAN assignment is a technology allowing the RADIUS server to send
the VLAN assignment to the port when the port is authenticated.

If the assigned VLAN does not exist on the switch, the switch will create the

related VLAN automatically, add the authenticated port to the VLAN and
change the PVID based on the assigned VLAN.

If the assigned VLAN exists on the switch, the switch will directly add the

authenticated port to the related VLAN and change the PVID instead of
creating a new VLAN.

If no VLAN is supplied by the RADIUS server or if 802.1x authentication is
disabled, the port will be in its original VLAN after successful authentication.
323

Syntax
dot1x vlan-assignment
no dot1x vlan-assignment

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the VLAN assignment feature:
T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x vlan-assignment

37.5

dot1x accounting
Description
The dot1x accounting command is used to enable the IEEE 802.1x

accounting function globally. To disable the IEEE 802.1x accounting function,
please use no dot1x accounting command.

Syntax
dot1x accounting
no dot1x accounting

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the enable the IEEE 802.1x accounting function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#dot1x accounting

324

37.6

dot1x mab
Description
The dot1x mab command is used to enable the MAB feature on the port.To

disable this feature, please use no dot1x mab command.

With MAB (MAC-Based Authentication Bypass) feature enabled, the switch
automatically sends the authentication server a RADIUS access request frame
with the client’s MAC address as the username and password. It is also
necessary to configure the RADIUS server with the client’s information for
authentication. You can enable this feature on IEEE 802.1x ports connected to
devices without 802.1x capability. For example, most printers, IP phones and
fax machines do not have 802.1x capability.

Syntax
dot1x mab
no dot1x mab

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the MAB feature on the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x mab

37.7

dot1x guest-vlan
Description
The dot1x guest-vlan command is used to configure the Guest VLAN

function on the port. To disable the Guest VLAN function, please use no
dot1x guest-vlan command.

325

Syntax
dot1x guest-vlan vid
no dot1x guest-vlan

Parameter
vid —— The VLAN ID needed to enable the Guest VLAN function, ranging
from 0 to 4094. 0 means that Guest VLAN is disabled. The supplicants in the
Guest VLAN can access the specified network source.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the Guest VLAN function for VLAN 5 and set the VLAN ID as 20 on the
Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1::

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x guest-vlan 5

37.8

dot1x timeout quiet-period
Description
The dot1x timeout quiet-period command is used to enable the quiet-period

function on the port. To disable the function, please use no dot1x timeout
quiet-period command.

Syntax
dot1x timeout quiet-period [ time ]
no dot1x timeout quiet-period

Parameter
time —— The length of the quiet-period time. If one user’s authentication fails,
its subsequent IEEE 802.1x authentication requests will not be processed
during the quiet-period time. It ranges from 1 to 999 seconds and the default
value is 10 seconds.

326

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the quiet-period function and set the quiet-period as 5 seconds on the

Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x quiet-period 5

37.9

dot1x timeout supp-timeout
Description
The dot1x timeout supp-timeout command is used to configure the

supplicant timeout on the port.To restore to the default, please use no dot1x

timeout supp-timeout command.

Syntax
dot1x timeout supp-timeout time

no dot1x timeout supp-timeout

Parameter
time ——The maximum time for the switch to wait for the response from

supplicant before resending a request to the supplicant., ranging from 1 to 9
in second. By default, it is 3 seconds.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the supplicant timeout value as 5 seconds on the Gigabit Ethernet
pot 1/0/1:

327

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x timeout supp-timeout 5

37.10 dot1x max- req
Description
The dot1x max-req command is used to configure the maximum transfer

times of the repeated authentication request when the server cannot be

connected. To restore to the default value, please use no dot1x max-req
command.

Syntax
dot1x max-req times
no dot1x max-req

Parameter
times —— The maximum transfer times of the repeated authentication

request, ranging from 1 to 9 in times. By default, the value is 3.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum transfer times of the repeated authentication
request as 5 on the Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x max-req 5

37.11 dot1x
Description
The dot1x command is used to enable the IEEE 802.1x function for a
specified port. To disable the IEEE 802.1x function for a specified port, please
use no dot1x command.

328

Syntax
dot1x
no dot1x

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet )

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the IEEE 802.1x function for the Gigabit Ethernet port 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x

37.12 dot1x port-control
Description
The dot1x port-control command is used to configure the Control Mode of
IEEE 802.1x for the specified port. By default, the control mode is “auto”. To

restore to the default configuration, please use no dot1x port-control

command.

Syntax
dot1x port-control {auto | authorized-force | unauthorized-force}
no dot1x port-control

Parameter
auto | authorized-force | unauthorized-force —— The Control Mode for the

port.

auto: In this mode, the port will normally work only after passing the 802.1x

Authentication.

authorized-force: In this mode, the port can work normally without passing

the 802.1x Authentication.

unauthorized-force: In this mode, the port is forbidden working for its fixed

unauthorized status.

329

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure

the

Control

Mode

“authorized-force”:

for

Gigabit

Ethernet

port

20

as

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x port-control authorized-force

37.13 dot1x port-method
Description
The dot1x port-method command is used to configure the control type of

IEEE 802.1x for the specified port. By default, the control type is “mac-based”.

To restore to the default configuration, please use no dot1x port-method
command.

Syntax
dot1x port-method { mac-based | port-based }
no dot1x port-method

Parameter
mac-based | port-based ——The control type for the port.
mac-based: Any client connected to the port should pass the 802.1x
authentication for access.

port-based: All the clients connected to the port can access the network on
the condition that any one of the clients has passed the 802.1x
Authentication.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

330

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the Control Type for Gigabit Ethernet port 20 as “port-based”:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#dot1x port-method port-based

37.14 dot1x auth-init
Description
The dot1x auth-init command is used to initialize the specific client.

Syntax
dot1x auth-init [ mac mac-address ]

Parameter
mac-address: Enter the MAC address of the client that will be unauthorized.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Initialize the client whose MAC address is a 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 on port 1:
T1600G-28TS(Config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#dot1x auth-init mac 00:02:58:4f:6c:23

37.15 dot1x auth-reauth
Description
The dot1x auth-reauth command is used to reauthenticate the specific

client.

331

Syntax
dot1x auth-reauth [ mac mac-address ]

Parameter
mac-address: Enter the MAC address of the client that will be
reauthenticated.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Reauthenticate the client whose MAC address is a 00:02:58:4f:6c:23 on port
1:

T1600G-28TS(Config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#dot1x auth-reauth mac 00:02:58:4f:6c:23

37.16 show dot1x global
Description
The show dot1x global command is used to display the global configuration
of 801.X.

Syntax
show dot1x global

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of 801.X globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x global

332

37.17 show dot1x interface
Description
The show dot1x interface command is used to display all ports or the
specified port’s configuration information of 801.X.

Syntax

show dot1x interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number. If not specified, the information of all the

ports will be displayed.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration information of 801.X for Gigabit Ethernet port 20:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/20
Display the configuration information of 801.X for all Ethernet ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x interface

37.18 show dot1x auth-state
Description
The show dot1x auth-state command is used to display the authentication

status of each port.

Syntax
show dot1x auth-state

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.
333

Example
Display the authentication status of each port:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show dot1x auth-state

334

Chapter 38 Port Security Commands
You can limit the number of MAC addresses that can be learned on each port on this page, thus
preventing the MAC address table from being exhausted by the attack packets.

38.1

mac address-table max-mac count
Description

The mac address-table max-mac-count command is used to enable the port

security feature of the port and configure the related parameters. To disable
the feature and restore the parameters to defaults on the port, please use no

Syntax

mac address-table max-mac-count command.

mac address-table max-mac-count { [ max-number num ]

[ exceed-max-learned enable | disable ] [ mode { dynamic | static |

permanent } ] [ status { forward | drop | disable } ] }

no mac address-table max-mac-count [ max-number | mode | status ]

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Set the maximum number of MAC addresses that can be learned on port
1/0/1 as 30, enable exceed-max-leaned feature and configure the mode as

permanent and the status as drop:

T1600G-28TS (config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#mac address-table max-mac-count max-number
30 exceed-maxlearned enable mode permanent status drop

38.2

show mac address-table max-mac-count
Description

The show mac address-table max-mac-count command is used to display

the port security configuration on each port.
335

Syntax

show mac address-table max-mac-count interface { fastEthernet port |
gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port }

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the port security configuration on port 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS# show mac address-table max-mac-count interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

336

Chapter 39 Port Mirroring Commands
Port Mirroring allows the switch to send a copy of the traffic that passes through specified

sources (ports, LAGs or the CPU) to a destination port. It does not affect the switching of
network traffic on source ports, LAGs or the CPU. Usually, the monitoring port is connected to
data diagnose device, which is used to analyze the monitored packets for monitoring and
troubleshooting the network.

39.1

monitor session destination interface
Description

The monitor session destination interface command is used to configure

the monitoring port. Each monitor session has only one monitoring port. To

change the monitoring port, please use the monitor session destination

interface command by changing the port value. The no monitor session

command is used to delete the corresponding monitoring port or monitor

Syntax

session.

monitor session session_num destination interface gigabitEthernet port

no monitor session session_num destination interface gigabitEthernet

port

no monitor session session_num

Parameter

session_num —— The monitor session number, can only be specified as 1.
port —— The monitoring port number.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example

Create monitor session 1 and configure port 1/0/1 as the monitoring port:
T1600G-28TS(config)#

monitor

session

1

destination

gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
Delete the monitoring port 1/0/2 from monitor session 1:
337

interface

T1600G-28TS(config)# no monitor session 1 destination interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
Delete the monitor session 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no monitor session 1

39.2

monitor session source
Description

The monitor session source command is used to configure the monitored

interface. To delete the corresponding monitored interface, please use no

Syntax

monitor session source command.

monitor session session_num source { cpu cpu_number | interface
gigabitEthernet port-list | interface port-channel port-channel-id } mode

no monitor session session_num source { cpu cpu_number | interface

gigabitEthernet port-list | interface port-channel port-channel-id } mode

Parameter

session_num —— The monitor session number. It can only be specified as 1.
cpu_number —— The CPU number. It can only be specified as 1.

port-list —— List of the Ethernet port number. It is multi-optional.
lag-list —— List of LAG interfaces. It is multi-optional.

mode —— The monitor mode. There are three options: rx, tx and both. Rx

(ingress monitoring mode), means the incoming packets received by the

monitored interface will be copied to the monitoring port. Tx (egress

monitoring mode), indicates the outgoing packets sent by the monitored
interface will be copied to the monitoring port. Both (ingress and egress

monitoring), presents the incoming packets received and the outgoing
packets sent by the monitored interface will both be copied to the monitoring
port.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

338

User Guidelines
1.

The monitoring port is corresponding to current interface configuration
mode.

2.

Monitored ports number is not limited, but it can’t be the monitoring port
at the same time.

3.

Whether the monitoring port and monitored ports are in the same VLAN
or not is not demanded strictly.

4.

Example

The monitoring port and monitored ports cannot be link-aggregation

member.

Create monitor session 1, then configure port 4, 5, 7 as monitored port and
enable ingress monitoring:

T1600G-28TS(config)# monitor session 1 source interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/4-5,1/0/7 rx
Delete port 4 in monitor session 1 and its configuration:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no monitor session 1 source interface
gigabitEthernet 1/0/4 rx

39.3

show monitor session
Description

The show monitor session command is used to display the configuration of

Syntax

port monitoring.

show monitor session [session_num]

Parameter

session_num —— The monitor session number, can only be specified as 1. It
is optional.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the monitoring configuration of monitor session 1:
339

T1600G-28TS(config)# show monitor session 1

340

Chapter 40 ACL Commands
ACL (Access Control List) is used to filter data packets by configuring a series of match

conditions, operations and time ranges. It provides a flexible and secured access control policy
and facilitates you to control the network security.

40.1

access-list create
Description
Syntax

The access-list create command is used to create an ACL.
access-list create acl-id [ name acl-name ]
no access-list create { acl-id }

Parameter

acl-id ——Enter an ACL ID. The IDs for MAC ACL are from 0 to 499. The IDs
for IP ACL are from 500 to 999. The IDs for IPv6 ACL are from 1500 to 1999.

acl-name —— Enter a name to identify the ACL.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create an IP ACL whose ID is 523:
T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list create 523

40.2

access-list resequence
Description

Syntax

The access-list resequence command is used to resequence the rules by
providing a Start Rule ID and Step value.
access-list resequence acl-id-or-name start start-rule-id step

rule-id-step-value

341

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— The ACL ID or name.
start-rule-id —— The start rule ID.

rule-id-step-value —— The step value.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Resequence the rules of ACL 12 with the start ID as 1 and step value as 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list resequence 12 start 1 step 5

40.3

access-list mac
Description

The access-list mac command is used to create MAC ACL. To delete the

Syntax

MAC ACL, please use no access-list mac.

access-list mac acl-id-or-name rule { auto | rule-id } { deny | permit } logging

{enable | disable} [smac source-mac smask source-mac-mask ] [dmac

destination-mac dmask destination-mac-mask ] [type ether-type] [pri
dot1p-priority] [vid vlan-id] [tseg time-range-name]
no access-list mac acl-id-or-name rule rule-id

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a
rule for.

auto —— The rule ID will be assigned automatically and the interval between
rule IDs is 5.

rule-id —— Assign an ID to the rule.
deny | permit —— Specify the action to be taken with the packets that match
the rule. By default, it is set to permit. The packets will be discarded if “deny”
is selected and forwarded if “permit” is selected.

enable | disable —— Enable or disable Logging function for the ACL rule. If

"enable " is selected, the times that the rule is matched will be logged every 5
342

minutes. With ACL Counter trap enabled, a related trap will be generated if
the matching times changes.

source-mac —— Enter the source MAC address. The format is

FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF.

source-mac-mask —— Enter the mask of the source MAC address. This is
required if a source MAC address is entered. The format is FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF.

destination-mac —— Enter the destination MAC address. The format is
FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF.

destination-mac-mask —— Enter the mask of the destination MAC address.

This is required if a destination MAC address is entered. The format is
FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF.

ether-type —— Specify an Ethernet-type with 4 hexadecimal numbers.

dot1p-priority: The user priority ranges from 0 to 7. The default is No Limit.
vlan-id —— The VLAN ID ranges from 1 to 4094.

time-range-name —— The name of the time-range. The default is No Limit.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create MAC ACL 50 and configure Rule 5 to permit packets with source MAC
address 00:34:a2:d4:34:b5:

T1600G-28TS (config)#access-list create 50
T1600G-28TS (config-mac-acl)#access-list mac 50 rule 5 permit logging
disable smac 00:34:a2:d4:34:b5 smask ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff

40.4

access-list ip
Description

The access-list ip command is used to add IP ACL rule. To delete the

corresponding rule, please use no access-list ip command. IP ACLs analyze

and process data packets based on a series of match conditions, which can

be the source IP addresses and destination IP addresses carried in the
packets.

343

Syntax

access-list ip acl-id-or-name rule {auto | rule-id } {deny | permit} logging

{enable | disable} [ sip sip-address sip-mask sip-address-mask ] [ dip

dip-address dip-mask dip-address-mask ] [dscp dscp-value] [tos tos-value]
[pre pre-value] [protocol protocol [s-port s-port-number] [s-port-mask

s-port-mask] [d-port d-port-number] [d-port-mask d-port-mask] [tcpflag
tcpflag]] [tseg time-range-name]

no access-list ip acl-id-or-name rule rule-id

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a
rule for.

auto —— The rule ID will be assigned automatically and the interval between
rule IDs is 5.

rule-id —— Assign an ID to the rule.
deny | permit —— Specify the action to be taken with the packets that match
the rule. By default, it is set to permit. The packets will be discarded if “deny”
is selected and forwarded if “permit” is selected.

logging {enable | disable} —— Enable or disable Logging function for the ACL

rule. If "enable " is selected, the times that the rule is matched will be logged
every 5 minutes. With ACL Counter trap enabled, a related trap will be
generated if the matching times changes.

sip-address —— Enter the source IP address.

sip-address-mask —— Enter the mask of the source IP address. This is

required if a source IP address is entered.

dip-address —— Enter the destination IP address.

dip-address-mask —— Enter the mask of the destination IP address. This is

required if a destination IP address is entered.

dscp-value —— Specify the DSCP value between 0 and 63.

tos-value ——Specify an IP ToS value to be matched between 0 and 15.

pre-value ——Specify an IP Precedence value to be matched between 0 and
7.

protocol —— Specify a protocol type.

s-port-number —— Specify the source port number.

s-port-mask —— Specify the source port mask with 4 hexadecimal numbers.

d-port-number —— Specify the destination port number.

344

d-port-mask —— Specify the destination port mask with 4 hexadacimal
numbers.

tcpflag —— For TCP protocol, specify the flag value using either binary
numbers or * (for example, 01*010*). The default is *, which indicates that the

flag will not be matched. The flags are URG (Urgent flag), ACK (acknowledge
flag), PSH(push flag), RST(reset flag),SYN(synchronize flag), and FIN(finish
flag).

time-range-name —— The name of the time-range. The default is No Limit.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Create IP ACL 600, and configure Rule 1 to permit packets with source IP
address 192.168.1.100:

T1600G-28TS (config)#access-list create 600
T1600G-28TS (config)#access-list ip 600 rule 1 permit logging disable sip
192.168.1.100 sip-mask 255.255.255.255

40.5

access-list ipv6
Description

The access-list ipv6 command is used to add IPv6 ACL rule. To delete the

corresponding rule, please use no access-list ipv6 command. IPv6 ACLs
analyze and process data packets based on a series of match conditions,

which can be the source IP addresses and destination IP addresses carried in

Syntax

the packets, the DSCP and flow-label value, etc.

access-list ipv6 acl-id-or-name rule {auto | rule-id } {deny | permit} logging

{enable | disable} [class class-value] [flow-label flow-label-value] [sip

source-ip-address sip-mask source-ip-mask] [dip destination-ip-address
dip-mask

destination-ip-mask]

[s-port

source-port-number]

destination-port-number] [tseg time-range-name]

no access-list ipv6 acl-id-or-name rule rule-id

345

[d-port

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a
rule for.

auto —— The rule ID will be assigned automatically and the interval between
rule IDs is 5.

rule-id —— Assign an ID to the rule.
deny | permit —— Specify the action to be taken with the packets that match
the rule. By default, it is set to permit. The packets will be discarded if “deny”
is selected and forwarded if “permit” is selected.

logging {enable | disable} —— Enable or disable Logging function for the ACL
rule. If "enable " is selected, the times that the rule is matched will be logged
every 5 minutes. With ACL Counter trap enabled, a related trap will be
generated if the matching times changes.

class-value —— Specify a class value to be matched. It ranges from 0 to 63.
flow-label-value —— Specify a Flow Label value to be matched.

source-ip-address —— Enter the source IP address. Enter the destination

IPv6 address to be matched. All types of IPv6 address will be checked. You
may enter a complete 128-bit IPv6 address but only the first 64 bits will be

valid.

source-ip-mask —— Enter the source IP address mask. The mask is required
if the source IPv6 address is entered. Enter the mask in complete format (for

example, ffff:ffff:0000:ffff). The mask specifies which bits in the source IPv6
address to match the rule.

destination-ip-address —— Enter the destination IPv6 address to be

matched. All types of IPv6 address will be checked. You may enter a
complete 128-bit IPv6 addresses but only the first 64 bits will be valid.

destination-ip-mask: Enter the source IP address mask. The mask is required

if the source IPv6 address is entered. Enter the mask in complete format (for

example, ffff:ffff:0000:ffff). The mask specifies which bits in the source IPv6
address to match the rule.

source-port-number —— Enter the TCP/UDP source port if TCP/UDP
protocol is selected.

destination-port-number —— Enter the TCP/UDP destination port if
TCP/UDP protocol is selected.

time-range-name —— The name of the time-range. The default is No Limit.

346

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

User Guidelines

Before binding an IPv6 ACL to a VLAN or interface, you should configure the
SDM template as “enterpriseV6” and save your configurations.

Example

Create IPv6 ACL 1600 and configure Rule 1 to deny packets with source IPv6
address CDCD:910A:2222:5498:8475:1111:3900:2020:
T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list create 1600
T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list ipv6 1600 rule 1 deny logging disable
sip CDCD:910A:2222:5498:8475:1111:3900:2020 sip-mask ffff:ffff:ffff:ffff

40.6

access-list action
Description

The access-list action command is used to specify a rule to be configured

with policies and enter Action Configuration mode. To delete the

Syntax

corresponding policies, please use no access-list action command.
access-list action acl-id-or-name rule rule-id

no access-list action acl-id-or-name rule rule-id

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL.
rule-id —— Enter the ID of the ACL rule.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Specify the rule 1 of ACL 200 to be configured with policies:
347

T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list action 200 rule 1

40.7

redirect interface
Description

The redirect interface command is used to define the policy to redirect the
matched packets to the desired port. To disable this policy, please use no

Syntax

redirect interface command.

redirect interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |

ten-gigabitEthernet port }

no redirect interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port }

Parameter

port —— The destination port to which the packets will be redirected. The
default is All.

Command Mode

Action Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Define the policy to redirect the matched packets to port 1/0/1 for rule 1 of
ACL 6:

T1600G-28TS(config)# access-list action 6 rule 1
T1600G-28TS(config-action)# redirect interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

40.8

s-condition
Description

The s-condition command is used to limit the rate of the matched packets.

Syntax

To restore the settings to the defaults, please use no s-condition.
s-condition rate rate burst burst-size osd { none | discard }
no s-condition
348

Parameter

rate —— Specify a rate, ranging from 0 to 1000000kbps.

burst-size —— Specify the number of bytes allowed in one second ranging
from 1 to 128.

osd ——Select either “none” or “discard” as the action to be taken for the
packets whose rate is beyond the specified rate. The default is None.

Command Mode

Action Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure a policy for rule 1 of ACL 6: limit the transmission rate of the

matched packets as 1000 Kbps and if the number of bytes per second is
beyond 100, the packets will be discarded by the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list action 6 rule 1
T1600G-28TS(config-action)# s-condition rate 1000 burst 100 osd discard

40.9

s-mirror
Description

The s-mirror command is used to define the policy to mirror the matched

packets to the desired port. To disable this policy, please use no s-mirror

Syntax

command.

s-mirror interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |

ten-gigabitEthernet port }

Parameter

port —— The destination port to which the packets will be mirrored.

Command Mode

Action Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

349

Example

Configure a policy for rule 1 of ACL 6: specify the mirror port as Gigabit
Ethernet port 1/0/2 for the data packets matching this rule:
T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list action 6 rule 1
T1600G-28TS(config-action)#s-mirror interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2

40.10 qos-remark
Description

The qos-remark command is used to configure QoS Remark function of

policy action. To restore the settings to the default, please use no

Syntax

qos-remark.

qos-remark [ dscp dscp ] [ priority pri ] [dot1p dot1p-pri]
no qos-remark

Parameter

dscp —— DSCP of QoS Remark. Specify the DSCP region for the data

packets matching the corresponding ACL. DSCP ranges from 0 to 63. By
default, it is not limited.

pri —— Local Priority of QoS Remark. Specify the local priority for the data
packets matching the corresponding ACL. Local Priority ranges from 0 to 7.

dot1p-pri —— 802.1P priority of QoS Remark. This remark configuration will

change the data packet's 802.1P priority field to the dot1p-pri you set. 802.1P

priority ranges from 0 to 7.
Note:

The DSCP and dot1p cannot be configured at the same time.

Command Mode

Action Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Configure a policy for rule 1 of ACL 6: specify the DSCP region as 30 and
local priority 2 for the packets matching this rule:

350

T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list action 6 rule 1
T1600G-28TS(config-action)# qos-remark dscp 30 priority 2

40.11 access bind
Description

The access-list policy name command is used to add Policy. To delete the

corresponding Policy, please use no access-list policy name command. A

Policy is used to control the data packets those match the corresponding

Syntax

ACL rules.

access-list bind acl-id-or-name interface { [ vlan vlan-list ] | [ fastEthernet

port-list ] | [gigabitEthernet port-list ] | [ ten-gigabitEthernet port-list ] }

no access-list bind acl-id-or-name interface { [ vlan vlan-list ] |
[ fastEthernet port-list ] | [gigabitEthernet port-list ] | [ ten-gigabitEthernet

port-list ] }

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— Enter the ID or name of the ACL that you want to add a
rule for.

vlan-list —— Specify the ID or the ID list of the VLAN(s) that you want to bind
the ACL to. The valid values are from 1 to 4094, for example, 2-3,5.

port-list —— Specify the number or the list of the Ethernet port that you want

to bind the ACL to.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example

Bind ACL 1 to port 3 and VLAN 4:
T1600G-28TS(config)#access-list bind 1 interface vlan 4 gigabitEthernet
1/0/3

351

40.12 show access-list
Description
Syntax

The show access-list command is used to display configuration of ACL.
show access-list acl-id-or-name

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— The ID or name of the ACL selected to display the
configuration.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the configuration of the MAC ACL whose ID is 20:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list 20

40.13 show access-list bind
Description

The show access-list bind command is used to display the configuration of

Syntax

ACL binding.

show access-list bind

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the configuration of Policy bind:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list bind

352

40.14 show access-list status
Description

The show access-list status command is used to display usage status of

Syntax

ACL entry resource.

show access-list status

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the usage status of ACL entry resource:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list status

40.15 show access-list counter
Description

The show access-list counter command is used to display the packet

Syntax

counter of a specified ACL.

show access-list acl-id-or-name counter

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— The ID or name of the ACL to display.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the packet counter of ACL 100:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show access-list 100 counter

353

40.16 clear access-list
Description

The show access-list command is used to clear the counter of matched

Syntax

packets of a specified ACL or rule.

clear access-list acl-id-or-name [rule rule-id]

Parameter

acl-id-or-name —— The ID or name of the ACL.
rule-id—— The ID of the rule.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Clear the packet counter of ACL 100:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear access-list 100

354

Chapter 41 IPv4 IMPB Commands
You can bind the IP address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host

together, which can be the condition for the ARP Inspection and IP verify source to filter the
packets.

41.1

ip source binding
Description
The ip source binding command is used to bind the IP address, MAC address,

VLAN ID and the Port number together manually. You can manually bind the
IP address, MAC address, VLAN ID and the Port number together in the

condition that you have got the related information of the Hosts in the LAN.

To delete the IP-MAC–VID-PORT entry from the binding table, please use no

ip source binding index command.

Syntax
ip source binding hostname ip-addr mac-addr vlan vlan-id interface

{ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port |

port-channel port-channel-id } { none | arp-detection | ip-verify-source |

both }

no ip source binding index ip-addr

Parameter
hostname ——The Host Name, which contains 20 characters at most.
ip-addr —— The IP address of the Host.

mac-addr —— The MAC address of the Host.

vlan-id ——The VLAN ID needed to be bound, ranging from 1 to 4094.
port —— The number of port connected to the Host.

none | arp-detection | ip-verify-source | both ——The protect type for the

entry. “arp-detection” indicates ARP detection; “ip-verify-source” indicates IP

source filter; “none” indicates applying none; “both” indicates applying both.

ip-addr —— The IP address of the entry to be deleted.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

355

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Bind an ACL entry with the IP 192.168.0.1, MAC 00:00:00:00:00:01, VLAN ID 2

and the Port number 5 manually. And then enable the entry for the ARP
detection:

T1600G-28TS(config)#ip source binding host1 192.168.0.1
00:00:00:00:00:01 vlan 2 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 arp-detection
Delete the IP-MAC–VID-PORT entry with the index 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)#no ip source binding index 5

41.2

ip dhcp snooping
Description
The ip dhcp snooping command is used to enable DHCP Snooping function

globally. To disable DHCP Snooping function globally, please use no ip dhcp

snooping command. DHCP Snooping functions to monitor the process of the

Host obtaining the IP address from DHCP server, and record the IP address,

MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host for
automatic binding.

Syntax
ip dhcp snooping
no ip dhcp snooping

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCP Snooping function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp snooping

356

41.3

ip dhcp snooping vlan
Description
The ip dhcp snooping vlan command is used to enable DHCP Snooping

function on a specified VLAN. To disable DHCP Snooping function on this
VLAN, please use no ip dhcp snooping vlan command.

Syntax
ip dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range

no ip dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range

Parameter
vlan-range —— Specify the VLANs to enable the DHCP snooping function, in

the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCP Snooping function on VLAN 1,4,6-7:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp snooping vlan 1,4,6-7

41.4

ip dhcp snooping max-entries
Description
The ip dhcp snooping max-entries command is used to configure the

maximum number of entries that can be learned on a port via DHCP Snooping.
To restore to the default setting, please use no ip dhcp snooping
max-entries command.

Syntax
ip dhcp snooping max-entries value
no ip dhcp snooping max-entries

357

Syntax
value —— Enter the value of maximum number of entries that can be learned
on the port via DHCP Snooping.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum number of entries that can be learned on port 1 as

100:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp snooping max-entries 100

41.5

show ip source binding
Description
The show ip source binding command is used to display the IP-MAC-VID-

PORT binding table.

Syntax
show ip source binding

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IP-MAC-VID-PORT binding table:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip source binding

358

41.6

show ip dhcp snooping
Description
The show ip dhcp snooping command is used to display the running status

of DHCP Snooping.

Syntax
show ip dhcp snooping

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the running status of DHCP Snooping:
T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp snooping

41.7

show ip dhcp snooping interface
Description
The show ip dhcp snooping interface command is used to display the DHCP

Snooping configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port/port channel or of
all Ethernet ports/port channels.

Syntax
show ip dhcp snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel

port-channel-id ]

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.
port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.
359

Example
Display the DHCP Snooping configuration of all Ethernet ports and port
channels:

T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp snooping interface
Display the DHCP Snooping configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5

360

Chapter 42 IPv6 IMPB Commands
You can bind the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port number of the

Host together, which can be the condition for the ARP Inspection and IP verify source to filter
the packets.

42.1

Ipv6 source binding
Description
The ipv6 source binding command is used to bind the IPv6 address, MAC
address, VLAN ID and the Port number together manually. You can manually

bind the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN ID and the Port number together
in the condition that you have got the related information of the Hosts in the

LAN. To delete the IPv6-MAC–VID-PORT entry from the binding table, please

use no ipv6 source binding index command.

Syntax
Ipv6 source binding hostname ipv6-addr mac-addr vlan vlan-id interface

{ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port |

port-channel port-channel-id } { none | nd-detection | ipv6-verify-source |

both }

no ipv6 source binding index ipv6-addr

Parameter
hostname ——The Host Name, which contains 20 characters at most.
Ipv6-addr —— The IP address of the Host.

mac-addr —— The MAC address of the Host.

vlan-id ——The VLAN ID needed to be bound, ranging from 1 to 4094.
port —— The number of port connected to the Host.

none | nd-detection | ipv6-verify-source | both ——The protect type for the

entry. “nd-detection” indicates ND detection; “ipv6-verify-source” indicates
IPv6 source filter; “none” indicates applying none; “both” indicates applying
both.

Ipv6-addr —— The IPv6 address of the entry to be deleted.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode
361

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
The following example shows how to bind an entry with the hostname host1,

IPv6 address 2001:0:9d38:90d5::34, MAC address AA-BB-CC-DD-EE-FF,

VLAN ID 10, port number 1/0/5, and enable this entry for ND Detection.

T1600G-28TS(config)# ipv6 source binding host1 2001:0:9d38:90d5::34
aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff vlan 10 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5 nd-detection

42.2

ipv6 dhcp snooping
Description
The ipv6 dhcp snooping command is used to enable DHCPv6 Snooping
function globally. To disable DHCPv6 Snooping function globally, please use
no ipv6 dhcp snooping command. DHCPv6 Snooping functions to monitor

the process of the Host obtaining the IP address from DHCPv6 server, and

record the IPv6 address, MAC address, VLAN and the connected Port
number of the Host for automatic binding.

Syntax
Ipv6 dhcp snooping
no ipv6 dhcp snooping

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCPv6 Snooping function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp snooping

362

42.3

ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan
Description
The ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan command is used to enable DHCP Snooping

function on a specified VLAN. To disable DHCP Snooping function on this
VLAN, please use no ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan command.

Syntax
ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range

no ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan vlan-range

Parameter
vlan-range —— Specify the VLANs to enable the DHCP snooping function, in

the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCPv6 Snooping function on VLAN 1,4,6-7:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp snooping vlan 1,4,6-7

42.4

ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries
Description
The ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries command is used to configure the
maximum number of entries that can be learned on a port via DHCPv6
Snooping. To restore to the default setting, please use no ipv6 dhcp

snooping max-entries command.

Syntax
Ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries value
no ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries

363

Syntax
value: Enter the value of maximum number of entries that can be learned on
the port via DHCPv6 Snooping.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum number of entries that can be learned on port 1 as
100:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 dhcp snooping max-entries 100

42.5

ipv6 nd snooping
Description
The ipv6 nd snooping command is used to enable ND snooping function
globally. To disable ND Snooping function globally, please use no ipv6 nd
snooping command. ND Snooping functions to monitor the process of the

duplication address detection, and record the IPv6 address, MAC address,
VLAN and the connected Port number of the Host for automatic binding.

Syntax
ipv6 nd snooping
no ipv6 nd snooping

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
364

Enable the ND snooping function globally:
T160G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd snooping

42.6

ipv6 nd snooping vlan
Description
The ipv6 nd snooping vlan command is used to enable ND snooping function
on a specified VLAN. To disable ND Snooping function on this VLAN, please
use no ipv6 nd snooping vlan command.

Syntax
ipv6 nd snooping vlan vlan-range

no ipv6 nd snooping vlan vlan-range

Parameter
vlan-range —— Specify the VLANs to enable the ND snooping function, in the

format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the ND snooping function on VLAN 1,4,6-7:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd snooping vlan 1,4,6-7

42.7

ipv6 nd snooping max-entries
Description
The ipv6 nd snooping max-entries command is used to specify the

maximum number of binding entries that are allow to be bound to a port. To
return the default, please use no ipv6 nd snooping max-entries command.

Syntax
ipv6 nd snooping max-entries value
365

no ipv6 nd snooping max-entries

Parameter
value —— Specify the maximum number of ND snooping entries on this
interface.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum number of binding entries from ND Snooping of
Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2 is 100:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 nd snooping max-entries 100

42.8

show ipv6 source binding
Description
The show ipv6 source binding command is used to display the
IPv6-MAC-VID- PORT binding table.

Syntax
show ipv6 source binding

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IPv6-MAC-VID-PORT binding table:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 source binding

366

42.9

show ipv6 dhcp snooping
Description
The show ipv6 dhcp snooping command is used to display the running
status of DHCPv6 Snooping.

Syntax
show ipv6 dhcp snooping

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the running status of DHCPv6 Snooping:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp snooping

42.10 show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface
Description
The show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface command is used to display the
DHCPv6 Snooping configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port/port
channel or of all Ethernet ports/port channels.

Syntax
show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface [ gigabitEthernet port | port-channel

port-channel-id ]

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.
port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.
367

Example
Display the DHCPv6 Snooping configuration of all Ethernet ports and port
channels:

T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface
Display the DHCPv6 Snooping configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp snooping interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5

42.11 show ipv6 nd snooping
Description
The show ipv6 nd snooping command is used to display the running status
of ND Snooping.

Syntax
show ipv6 nd snooping

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the running status of ND Snooping:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 nd snooping

368

Chapter 43 IP Verify Source Commands
IP Verify Source is to filter the IP packets based on the IP-MAC Binding entries. Only the
packets matched to the IP-MAC Binding rules can be processed, which can enhance the

bandwidth utility.

43.1

ip verify source
Description
The ip verify source command is used to configure the IP Verify Source
mode for a specified port. To disable the IP Verify Source function, please use
no ip verify source command.

Syntax
ip verify source { sip+mac | sip }
no ip verify source

Parameter
sip+mac —— Security type. “sip+mac” indicates that only the packets with its

source IP address, source MAC address and port number matched to the
IP-MAC binding rules can be processed.

sip —— Security type. “sip” indicates that only the packets with its source IP

address and port number matched to the IP-MAC binding rules can be
processed.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the IP Verify Source function for Gigabit Ethernet ports 5-10.

Configure that only the packets with its source IP address, source MAC
address and port number matched to the IP-MAC binding rules can be
processed:

369

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/5-10
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip verify source sip+mac

43.2

ip verify source logging
Description
The ip verify source logging command is used to enable the log feature.
With this feature enabled, the switch will generate a log when illegal packets

are received. To disable the log feature, please use no ip verify source
logging command.

Syntax
ip verify source logging
no ip verify source logging

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the log feature to make the switch generate logs when receiving illegal
packets:

T1600G-28TS(config)#ip verify source logging

43.3

show ip verify source
Description
The show ip verify source command is used to display the IP Verify Source
configuration information.

Syntax
show ip verify source

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
370

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IP Verify Source configuration information:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip verify source

43.4

show ip verify source interface
Description
The show ip verify source interface command is used to display the IP verify
source configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port.

Syntax
show ip verify source interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.
port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IP verify source configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS#show ip verify source interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5

371

Chapter 44 IPv6 Verify Source Commands
IPv6 Verify Source is to filter the IPv6 packets based on the IPv6-MAC Binding entries. Only the
packets matched to the IPv6-MAC Binding rules can be processed, which can enhance the

bandwidth utility.

Before configuring IPv6 Verify Source feature, you should configure the SDM template as
“enterpriseV6” and save your configurations.

44.1

ipv6 verify source
Description
The ipv6 verify source command is used to configure the IPv6 Verify Source

mode for a specified port. To disable the IPv6 Verify Source function, please
use no ipv6 verify source command.

Syntax
ipv6 verify source { sipv6+mac | sipv6 }
no ipv6 verify source

Parameter
sipv6+mac —— Security type. “sipv6+mac” indicates that only the packets
with its source IPv6 address, source MAC address and port number matched
to the IPv6-MAC binding rules can be processed.

sipv6 —— Security type. “sipv6” indicates that only the packets with its
source IPv6 address and port number matched to the IPv6-MAC binding rules
can be processed.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet )

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the IPv6 Verify Source function for Gigabit Ethernet ports 5-10.
Configure that only the packets with its source IPv6 address, source MAC
372

address and port number matched to the IPv6-MAC binding rules can be

processed:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/5-10
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 verify source sipv6+mac

44.2

show ipv6 verify source
Description
The show ipv6 verify source command is used to display the IPv6 Verify

Source configuration information.

Syntax
show ipv6 verify source

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IPv6 Verify Source configuration information:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 verify source

44.3

show ipv6 verify source interface
Description
The show ipv6 verify source interface command is used to display the IPv6
verify source configuration of a desired Gigabit Ethernet port.

Syntax
show ipv6 verify source interface gigabitEthernet port

Parameters
port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode
373

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the IPv6 verify source configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 verify source interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5

374

Chapter 45 DHCPv4 Filter Commands
DHCPv4 Filter function allows the user to not only to restrict all DHCP Server packets but also

to receive any specified DHCP server packet by any specified DHCP client, it is useful when
one or more DHCP servers are present on the network and both provide DHCP services to
different distinct groups of clients.

45.1

ip dhcp filter
Description
The ip dhcp filter command is used to enable DHCP Filter function globally.

To disable DHCP Filter function globally, please use no ip dhcp filter

command.

Syntax
ip dhcp filter
no ip dhcp filter

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCP Filter function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dhcp filter

45.2

ip dhcp filter (interface)
Description
The ip dhcp filter (interface) command is used to enable DHCP Filter

function on a specified port. To disable DHCP Filter function on this port,
please use no ip dhcp filter (interface) command.

375

Syntax
ip dhcp filter
no ip dhcp filter

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCP Filter on port 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#ip dhcp filter

45.3

ip dhcp filter mac-verify
Description
The ip dhcp filter mac-verify command is used to enable the MAC Verify

feature. To disable the MAC Verify feature, please use no ip dhcp filter
mac-verify command. There are two fields of the DHCP packet containing

the MAC address of the Host. The MAC Verify feature is to compare the two
fields and discard the packet if the two fields are different.

Syntax
ip dhcp filter mac-verify
no ip dhcp filter mac-verify

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

376

Example
Enable the MAC Verify feature for the Gigabit Ethernet port 10/2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp filter mac-verify

45.4

ip dhcp filter limit rate
Description
The ip dhcp filter limit rate command is used to enable the Flow Control

feature for the DHCP packets. The excessive DHCP packets will be discarded.
To restore to the default configuration, please use no ip dhcp filter limit rate
command.

Syntax
ip dhcp filter limit rate value

no ip dhcp filter limit rate

Parameter
value —— The value of Flow Control. The options are 5/10/15/20/25/30
(packet/second). The default value is 0, which stands for “disable”.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the Flow Control of GigabitEthernet port 2 as 20 pps:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp filter limit rate 20

377

45.5

ip dhcp filter decline rate
Description
The ip dhcp filter decline rate command is used to enable the Decline

Protect feature and configure the rate limit on DHCP Decine packets. The
excessive DHCP Decline packets will be discarded. To disable the Decline
Protect feature, please use no ip dhcp filter decline rate command.

Syntax
ip dhcp filter decline rate value
no ip dhcp filter decline rate

Parameter
value —— Specify the rate limit of DHCP Decline packets, and the optional

values are 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25 and 30 (units:packet/second). It default value is
0, which stands for “disable”.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the rate limit of DHCP Decline packets as 20 packets per second
on Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip dhcp filter decline 20

45.6

ip dhcp filter server permit-entry
Description
The ip dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to add entry for the

legal DHCP server. To restore to the default option, please use no ip dhcp

snooping information strategy command.

378

Syntax
ip dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr client-mac macAddr

interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet

port | interface port-channel port-channel-id }

no ip dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr client-mac macAddr

interface { fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet

port | interface port-channel port-channel-id }

Parameter
ipAddr —— Specify the IP address of the legal DHCPv4 server.

macAddr —— Specify the MAC address of the DHCP Client. The value “all”
means all client mac addresses.

port-list | port-channel-id —— Specify the port that the legal DHCPv4 server
is connected to.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create an entry for the legal DHCPv4 server whose IP address is
192.168.0.100 and connected port number is 1/0/1 without client MAC
address restricted:

T1600G-28TS(config)#ip

dhcp

filter

server

permit-entry

server-ip

192.168.0.100 client-mac all interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1

45.7

show ip dhcp filter
Description
The show ip dhcp filter command is used to display the configuration of
DHCP Filter.

Syntax
show ip dhcp filter

379

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the DHCP Filter configuration:
T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp filter

45.8

show ip dhcp filter interface
Description
The show ip dhcp filter interface command is used to display the
configuration of DHCP Filter on ports.

Syntax
show ip dhcp filter interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |

ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the DHCP Filter configuration on port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp filter interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3

45.9

show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry
Description
The show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to display the
legal server configuration.

Syntax
show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry
380

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the legal DHCP server configuration:
T1600G-28TS#show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry

381

Chapter 46 DHCPv6 Filter Commands
DHCPv6 Filter function allows the user to not only to restrict all DHCPv6 Server packets but
also to receive any specified DHCPv6 server packet by any specified DHCPv6 client, it is useful

when one or more DHCPv6 servers are present on the network and both provide DHCPv6
services to different distinct groups of clients.

46.1

ipv6 dhcp filter
Description
The ipv6 dhcp filter command is used to enable DHCP Filter function globally.

To disable DHCPv6 Filter function globally, please use no ipv6 dhcp filter
command.

Syntax
Ipv6 dhcp filter
no ipv6 dhcp filter

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCPv6 Filter function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp filter

46.2

ipv6 dhcp filter (interface)
Description
The ipv6 dhcp filter (interface) command is used to enable DHCPv6 Filter

function on a specified port. To disable DHCPv6v Filter function on this port,
please use no ipv6 dhcp filter (interface) command.

382

Syntax
ipv6 dhcp filter
no ipv6 dhcp filter

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DHCPv6 Filter on port 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
T1600G-28TS(Config-if)#ipv6 dhcp filter

46.3

ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate
Description
The ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate command is used to enable the Flow Control

feature for the DHCPv6 packets. The excessive DHCPv6 packets will be
discarded. To restore to the default configuration, please use no ipv6 dhcp
filter limit rate command.

Syntax
Ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate value
no ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate

Parameter
value —— The value of Flow Control. The options are 5/10/15/20/25/30
(packet/second). The default value is 0, which stands for “disable”.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

383

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Set the Flow Control of GigabitEthernet port 2 as 20 pps:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 dhcp filter limit rate 20

46.4

ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate
Description
The ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate command is used to enable the Decline

Protect feature and configure the rate limit on DHCP Decine packets. The
excessive DHCPv6 Decline packets will be discarded. To disable the Decline
Protect feature, please use no ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate command.

Syntax
Ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate value
no ipv6 dhcp filter decline rate

Parameter
value —— Specify the rate limit of DHCPv6 Decline packets, and the optional

values are 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25 and 30 (units:packet/second). It default value is
0, which stands for “disable”.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet / interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

384

Example
Configure the rate limit of DHCPv6 Decline packets as 20 packets per second
on Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/2:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ipv6 dhcp filter decline 20

46.5

ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry
Description
The ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to add entry for

the legal DHCPv6 server. To restore to the default option, please use no ipv6
dhcp snooping information strategy command.

Syntax
Ipv6

dhcp

filter

server

permit-entry

server-ip

ipAddr

interface

{ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port |

interface port-channel port-channel-id }

no ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip ipAddr interface

{ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port | ten-gigabitEthernet port |

interface port-channel port-channel-id }

Parameter
ipAddr —— Specify the IPv6 address of the legal DHCPv6 server.

port-list | port-channel-id —— Specify the port that the legal DHCPv6 server
is connected to.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Create an entry for the legal DHCPv6 server whose IP address is
192.168.0.100 and connected port number is 1/0/1:

T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry server-ip
2003::1 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
385

46.6

show ipv6 dhcp filter
Description
The show ipv6 dhcp filter command is used to display the configuration of
DHCPv6 Filter.

Syntax
show ipv6 dhcp filter

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the DHCPv6 Filter configuration:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp filter

46.7

show ipv6 dhcp filter interface
Description
The show ipv6 dhcp filter interface command is used to display the

configuration of DHCPv6 Filter on ports.

Syntax
show ipv6 dhcp filter interface [fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the DHCPv6 Filter configuration on port 1/0/3:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp filter interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3

386

46.8

show ip dhcp filter server permit-entry
Description
The show ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry command is used to display

the legal server configuration.

Syntax
show ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the legal DHCPv6 server configuration:
T1600G-28TS#show ipv6 dhcp filter server permit-entry

387

Chapter 47 DoS Defend Commands
DoS (Denial of Service) Attack is to occupy the network bandwidth maliciously by the network
attackers or the evil programs sending a lot of service requests to the Host. With the DoS

Defend enabled, the switch can analyze the specific field of the received packets and provide
the defend measures to ensure the normal working of the local network.

47.1

ip dos-prevent
Description
The ip dos-prevent command is used to enable the DoS defend function
globally. To disable the DoS defend function, please use no ip dos-prevent
command.

Syntax
ip dos-prevent
no ip dos-prevent

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DoS defend function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dos-prevent

47.2

ip dos-prevent type
Description
The ip dos-prevent type command is used to select the DoS Defend Type.
To disable the corresponding Defend Type, please use no ip dos-prevent
type command.

388

Syntax
ip dos-prevent type { land | scan-synfin | xma-scan | null-scan |

port-less-1024 | blat | ping-flood | syn-flood | win-nuke | ping-of-death |

smurf }

no ip dos-prevent type { land | scan-synfin | xma-scan | null-scan |

port-less-1024 | blat | ping-flood | syn-flood | win-nuke | ping-of-death |

smurf }

Parameter
land ——The attacker sends a specific fake SYN (synchronous) packet to the

destination host. Because both of the source IP address and the destination

IP address of the SYN packet are set to be the IP address of the host, the
host will be trapped in an endless circle of building the initial connection.

scan-synfin ——The attacker sends the packet with its SYN field and the FIN

field set to 1. The SYN field is used to request initial connection whereas the
FIN field is used to request disconnection. Therefore, the packet of this type
is illegal.

xma-scan ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with its TCP index, FIN,
URG and PSH field set to 1.

null-scan ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with its TCP index and all
the control fields set to 0. During the TCP connection and data transmission,
the packets with all control fields set to 0 are considered illegal.

port-less-1024 ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with its TCP SYN
field set to 1 and source port smaller than 1024.

blat ——The attacker sends the illegal packet with the same source port and

destination port on Layer 4 and with its URG field set to 1. Similar to the Land
Attack, the system performance of the attacked host is reduced because the
Host circularly attempts to build a connection with the attacker.

ping-flood ——The attacker floods the destination system with Ping packets,

creating a broadcast storm that makes it impossible for the system to
respond to legal communication.

syn-flood ——The attacker uses a fake IP address to send TCP request

packets to the server. Upon receiving the request packets, the server
responds with SYN-ACK packets. Since the IP address is fake, no response
will be returned. The server will keep on sending SYN-ACK packets. If the

attacker sends overflowing fake request packets, the network resource will
be occupied maliciously and the requests of the legal clients will be denied.

win-nuke ——Because the Operation System with bugs cannot correctly
process the URG (Urgent Pointer) of TCP packets, the attacker sends this
389

type of packets to the TCP port139 (NetBIOS) of the host with the Operation
System bugs, which will cause the host with a blue screen.

ping-of-death ——Ping of Death attack means that the attacker sends

abnormal ping packets larger than 65535 bytes to cause system crash on the
target computer.

smurf ——Smurf attack is a distributed denial-of-service attack in which large

numbers of Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets with the
intended victim’s spoofed source IP are broadcast to a computer network

using an IP broadcast address. Most devices on a network will, by default,
respond to this by sending a reply to the source IP address. If the number of
machines on the network that receive and respond to these packets is very
large, the victim’s computer will be flooded with traffic.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the DoS Defend Type named Land attack:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip dos-prevent type land

47.3

show ip dos-prevent
Description
The show ip dos-prevent command is used to display the DoS information of
the detected DoS attack, including enable/disable status, the DoS Defend
Type, the count of the attack, etc.

Syntax
show ip dos-prevent

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

390

Example
Display the DoS information of the detected DoS attack globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip dos-prevent

391

Chapter 48 DLDP Commands
DLDP (Device Link Detection Protocol) is used to monitor the link state of fiber-optic or
twisted-pair Ethernet cables. When a unidirectional link is detected, the corresponding port will
be shut down automatically or manually (depending on the shut mode configured).

48.1

dldp (global)
Description
The dldp command is used to enable the DLDP function globally. To disable it,
please use no dldp command.

Syntax
dldp
no dldp

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable the DLDP function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)# dldp

48.2

dldp interval
Description
The dldp interval command is used to define the interval of sending
advertisement packets on ports that are in the advertisement state.

Syntax
dldp interval interval-time

Parameter
interval-time —— The interval of sending advertisement packets. It ranges
from 1 to 30 seconds. By default, it is 5 seconds.
392

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Specify the interval of sending advertisement packets as 10 seconds:
T1600G-28TS(config)# dldp interval 10

48.3

dldp shut-mode
Description
The dldp shut-mode command is used to configure the shutdown mode

when a unidirectional link is detected.

Syntax
dldp shut-mode { auto | manual }

Parameter
auto —— The switch automatically shuts down ports when a unidirectional
link is detected. By default, the shut-mode is auto.

manual ——The switch displays an alert when a unidirectional link is detected.

The operation to shut down the unidirectional link ports is accomplished by
the users.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Configure the shut-mode as manual:
T1600G-28TS(config)# dldp shut-mode manual

393

48.4

dldp(interface)
Description
The dldp command is used to enable the DLDP function of the specified port.
To disable it, please use no dldp command.

Syntax
dldp
no dldp

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable the DLDP function of ports 1/0/2-4:
T1600G-28TS (config)# interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-4
T1600G-28TS (config-if-range)# dldp

48.5

show dldp
Description
The show dldp command is used to display the global configuration of DLDP

function such as DLDP global state, DLDP interval and shut mode.

Syntax
show dldp

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the global configuration of DLDP function:
394

T1600G-28TS# show dldp

48.6

show dldp interface
Description
The show dldp interface command is used to display the configuration and
state of the specified Ethernet port. By default, the configuration and state of
all the ports will be displayed.

Syntax
show dldp interface [gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameter
port —— The Gigabit Ethernet port number.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration and state of all ports:
T1600G-28TS# show dldp interface
Display the configuration and state of port 1/0/5:
T1600G-28TS# show dldp interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5

395

Chapter 49 SNMP Commands
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) functions are used to manage the network
devices for a smooth communication, which can facilitate the network administrators to
monitor the network nodes and implement the proper operation.

49.1

snmp-server
Description

The snmp-server command is used to enable the SNMP function. By default,

it is disabled. To return to the default configuration, please use no

Syntax

snmp-server command.
snmp-server
no snmp-server

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the SNMP function:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server

49.2

snmp-server view
Description

The snmp-server view command is used to add View. To delete the

corresponding View, please use no snmp-server view command. The OID
(Object Identifier) of the SNMP packets is used to describe the managed
objects of the switch, and the MIB (Management Information Base) is the set

of the OIDs. The SNMP View is created for the SNMP management station to

Syntax

manage MIB objects.

snmp-server view name mib-oid { include | exclude }

no snmp-server view name mib-oid
396

Parameter

name —— The entry name of View, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. Each
View includes several entries with the same name.

mib-oid —— MIB Object ID. It is the Object Identifier (OID) for the entry of

View, ranging from 1 to 61 characters.

include | exclude —— View Type, with include and exclude options. They

represent the view entry can/cannot be managed by the SNMP management
station individually.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Add a View named view1, configuring the OID as 1.3.6.1.6.3.20, and this OID
can be managed by the SNMP management station:

T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server view view1 1.3.6.1.6.3.20 include

49.3

snmp-server group
Description

The snmp-server group command is used to manage and configure the

SNMP group. To delete the corresponding SNMP group, please use no

snmp-server group command. SNMP v3 provides the VACM (View-based

Access Control Model) and USM (User-Based Security Model) mechanisms
for authentication. The users in the SNMP Group can manage the device via
the Read View, Write View and Notify View. And the authentication mode and

the privacy mode guarantee the high security for the communication

Syntax

between the management station and the managed device.

snmp-server group name [ smode v3 ] [ slev { noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv |
authPriv }] [ read read-view ] [ write write-view ] [ notify notify-view ]

no snmp-server group name smode v3 slev { noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv |
authPriv }

Parameter

name ——The SNMP Group name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. The
Group Name, Security Model and Security Level compose the identifier of the
397

SNMP Group. These three items of the Users in one group should be the
same.

v3 —— The security mode for the group, v3 indicates SNMPv3, the most
secure level.
slev —— The Security Level of SNMP v3 Group. There are three options,
including noAuthNoPriv (no authorization and no encryption), authNoPriv
(authorization and no encryption) and authPriv (authorization and encryption).
By default, the Security Level is noAuthNoPriv. There is no need to configure
this in SNMP v1 Mode and SNMP v2c Mode.

read-view —— Select the View to be the Read View. The management access

is restricted to read-only, and changes cannot be made to the assigned
SNMP View.

write-view —— Select the View to be the Write View. The management

access is writing only and changes can be made to the assigned SNMP View.
The View defined both as the Read View and the Write View can be read and
modified.

notify-view —— Select the View to be the Notify View. The management

station can receive notification messages of the assigned SNMP view
generated by the switch's SNMP agent.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Add a group, and configure the name as group 1, the Security Model as SNMP
v3, the security level as authNoPriv, the management access to the assigned
View viewDefault as read-write, besides the notification messages sent by
View viewDefault can be received by Management station:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server group group1 smode v3 slev
authNoPriv read viewDefault write viewDefault notify viewDefault
Delete group 1:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no snmp-server group group1 smode v3 slev
authNoPriv

398

49.4

snmp-server user
Description

The snmp-server user command is used to add User. To delete the

corresponding User, please use no snmp-server user command. The User in

an SNMP Group can manage the switch via the management station software.

Syntax

The User and its Group have the same security level and access right.

snmp-server user name { local | remote } group-name [ smode v3 ] [ slev

{ noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv | authPriv }] [ cmode { none | MD5 | SHA }] [ cpwd

confirm-pwd ] [ emode { none | DES }] [ epwd encrypt-pwd ]

no snmp-server user name

Parameter

name —— User Name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.
local | remote —— User Type, with local and remote options. Local indicates
that the user is connected to a local SNMP engine, while remote means that

the user is connected to a remote SNMP engine. As the remote engine ID and
user password are used to compute the authentication and privacy digests,

before configuring a remote user, you need to set the remote engine ID first.

group-name —— The Group Name of the User. The User is classified to the
corresponding Group according to its Group Name, Security Model and
Security Level.

v3 ——The security mode for the user. v3 indicates SNMPv3, the most
secure model.

slev —— The Security Level of SNMP v3 Group. There are three options,

including noAuthNoPriv (no authorization and no encryption), authNoPriv

(authorization and no encryption) and authPriv (authorization and encryption).
The security level from highest to lowest is: noAuthNoPriv, authNoPriv,

authPriv, and the default is noAuthNoPriv. The security level of the user

should not be lower than the group it belongs to.

cmode —— The Authentication Mode of the SNMP v3 User, with none, MD5
and SHA options. None indicates no authentication method is used, MD5

indicates the port authentication is performed via HMAC-MD5 algorithm and

SHA indicates the port authentication is performed via SHA (Secure Hash

Algorithm). SHA authentication mode has a higher security than MD5 mode.
By default, the Authentication Mode is “none”.

399

confirm-pwd —— Authentication Password, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.

The question marks and spaces are not allowed. This password in the
configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric encrypted form.

emode —— The Privacy Mode of the SNMP v3 User, with none and DES

options. None indicates no privacy method is used, and DES indicates DES
encryption method is used. By default, the Privacy Mode is “none”.

encrypt-pwd —— Privacy Password, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. The
question marks and spaces are not allowed. This password in the

configuration file will be displayed in the symmetric encrypted form.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Add Local User admin to Group group2, and configure the Security Model of

the user as v3, the Security Level of the group as authPriv, the Authentication

Mode of the user as MD5, the Authentication Password as 11111, the Privacy
Mode as DES, and the Privacy Password as 22222:

T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server user admin local group2 smode v3
slev authPriv cmode MD5 cpwd 11111 emode DES epwd 22222

49.5

snmp-server community
Description

The snmp-server community command is used to add Community. To

delete the corresponding Community, please use no snmp-server

community command. SNMP v1 and SNMP v2c adopt community name
authentication. The community name can limit access to the SNMP agent

Syntax

from SNMP network management station, functioning as a password.
snmp-server community name { read-only | read-write } mib-view

no snmp-server community name

Parameter

name —— Community Name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.

read-only | read-write —— The access rights of the community, with
read-only and read-write options.
400

mib-view —— The MIB View for the community to access.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Add community public, and the community has read-write management right

to View viewDefault:

T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server community public read-write
viewDefault

49.6

snmp-server host
Description

The snmp-server host command is used to add Notification. To delete the

Syntax

corresponding Notification, please use no snmp-server host command.

snmp-server host ip udp-port user-name [ smode { v1 | v2c | v3 }] [ slev

{ noAuthNoPriv | authNoPriv | authPriv }] [ type { trap | inform }] [ retries retries ]
[ timeout timeout ]

no snmp-server host ip user-name

Parameter

ip —— The IP Address of the management Host. Both IPv4 and IPv6
addresses are supported, for example 192.168.0.100 or fe80::1234.

udp-port —— UDP port, which is used to send notifications. The UDP port
functions with the IP address for the notification sending. It ranges from 1 to
65535.

user-name —— The User name of the management station.

smode —— The Security Model of the management station, with v1, v2c and

v3 options. By default, the option is v1.

slev —— The Security Level of SNMP v3 Group. There are three options,
including noAuthNoPriv (no authorization and no encryption), authNoPriv
(authorization and no encryption) and authPriv (authorization and encryption).
By default, the option is “noAuthNoPriv”.

401

type —— The type of the notifications, with trap and inform options. Trap
indicates traps are sent, while inform indicates informs are sent. The inform
type has a higher security than the trap type and resend and timeout need to

be configured if you select this option. You can only select the trap type in
Security Model v1. By default, the type of the notifications is “trap”.

retries —— The amount of times the switch retries an inform request, ranging
from 1 to 255. The switch will resend the inform request if it doesn’t get the

response from the management station during the Timeout interval, and it will
terminate resending the inform request if the resending times reach the
specified Retry times.

timeout —— The maximum time for the switch to wait for the response from

the management station before resending a request, ranging from 1 to 3600
in seconds.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Add a Notification entry, and configure the IP address of the management

Host as 192.168.0.146, the UDP port as 162, the User name of the
management station as admin, the Security Model of the management station
as v2c, the type of the notifications as inform, the maximum time for the
switch to wait as 1000 seconds, and the retries time as 100:

T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server host 192.168.0.146 162 admin smode
v2c type inform retries 100 timeout 1000
Add a Notification entry, and configure the IP Address of the management
Host as fe80::1234, the UDP port as 162, the User name of the management

station as admin, the Security Model of the management station as v2c, the
type of the notifications as inform, the maximum time for the switch to wait as
1000 seconds, and the retries time as 100:

T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server host fe80::1234 162 admin smode v2c
type inform retries 100 timeout 1000

402

49.7

snmp-server engineID
Description

The snmp-server engineID command is used to configure the local and

remote engineID of the switch. To restore to the default setting, please use

Syntax

no snmp-server engineID command.

snmp-server engineID { [ local local-engineID ] [ remote remote-engineID ] }

no snmp-server engineID

Parameter

local-engineID —— Local Engine ID for local clients. The Engine ID is a unique

alphanumeric string used to identify the SNMP engine on the switch. Its
length ranges from 10 to 64 hexadecimal characters, which must be even
number meanwhile.

remote-engineID —— Remote Engine ID for the switch. The Engine ID is a

unique alphanumeric string used to identify the SNMP engine on the remote
device which receives informs from the switch. Its length ranges from 10 to

64 hexadecimal characters, which must be even number meanwhile. The

snmp-server engineID will be disabled if the local and remote are both not

configured.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Specify the local engineID as 1234567890, and the remote engineID as
abcdef123456:

T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server engineID local 1234567890 remote
abcdef123456

49.8

snmp-server traps snmp
Description

The snmp-server traps snmp command is used to enable SNMP standard

traps which include four types: linkup, linkdown, warmstart and coldstart. The
command without parameter enables all SNMP standard traps. All SNMP
403

standard traps are enabled by default. To disable the sending of SNMP

Syntax

standard traps, please use no snmp-server traps snmp command.

snmp-server traps snmp [ linkup | linkdown | warmstart | coldstart |

auth-failure ]

no snmp-server traps snmp [ linkup | linkdown | warmstart | coldstart |
auth-failure ]

Parameter

linkup —— Indicates a port status changes from linkdown to linkup, and can
be triggered when you connect a device to a port.

linkdown —— Indicates a port status changes from linkup to linkdown, and

can be triggered when you disconnect a device to a port.

warmstart —— Indicates the SNMP feature on the switch is reinitialized with

the physical configuration unchanged. The trap can be triggered if you

disable and then enable SNMP after the SNMP is completely configured and
enabled.

coldstart —— Indicates an SNMP initialization caused by the reinitialization of
the switch system. The trap can be triggered when you reboot the switch.

auth-failure —— Triggered when a received SNMP request fails the

authentication.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable SNMP standard linkup trap for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps snmp linkup

49.9

snmp-server traps
Description

The snmp-server traps command is used to enable SNMP extended traps.

To disable the sending of SNMP extended traps, please use no snmp-server
traps command. All SNMP extended traps are disabled by default.

404

Syntax

snmp-server traps { rate-limit | cpu | flash | lldp remtableschange | lldp

topologychange | loopback-detection | storm-control | spanning-tree |

memory }
no

snmp-server

traps

{

bandwidth-control

|

cpu

|

flash

|

lldp

remtableschange | lldp topologychange | loopback-detection | storm-control

| spanning-tree | memory }

Parameter

rate-limit ——Monitors whether the bandwidth has reached the limit you have
set. The trap can be triggered when the Rate Limit feature is enabled and
packets are sent to the port with a rate higher than what you have set.

cpu ——Monitors the load status of the switch CPU. The trap can be
triggered when the utilization rate of the CPU has exceeded the limit that you
have set. The limit of CPU utilization rate for the switch is 80% by default.

flash ——Triggered when flash is modified during operations such as backup,

reset, firmware upgrade, configuration import, and so on.

lldp remtableschange ——An lldp RemTablesChange notification is sent

when the value of lldp StatsRemTableLastChangeTime changes. It can be
utilized by an NMS host to trigger LLDP remote systems table maintenance
polls.

lldp topologychange ——A notification generated by the local device to
sense the change in the topology that indicates a new remote device

attached to a local port, or a remote device disconnected or moved from one
port to another.

loopback-detection ——The feature is used to detect loopbacks. And the

trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap when a loopback
is detected or cleared.

storm-control ——The feature is used to monitor network storms. And the
trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap when the rate of
broadcast or multicast reaches the limit of storm control.

spanning-tree ——The feature is used to monitor the spanning tree status.
And the trap is disabled by default. The system will generate the trap in the

following situations: a port changes from non-forwarding state to forwarding
state or the other way round; a port receives a packet with TC flag or a TCN
packet.

405

memory ——The feature is used to monitor the memory. And the trap is

disabled by default. The system will generate the trap when the memory
utilization exceeds 80%.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable SNMP extended bandwidth-control trap for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps bandwidth-control

49.10 snmp-server traps ddm
Note: Only T1600G-28TS supports DDM traps.

Description

The snmp-server traps ddm command is used to enable the corresponding

DDM traps. DDM function is used to monitor the status of the SFP modules
inserted into the SFP ports on the switch. The command without parameter

enables all SNMP DDM traps. To disable the sending of SNMP DDM traps, use

Syntax

no snmp-server traps ddm command. All DDM traps are disabled by default.

snmp-server traps ddm [ temperature | voltage | bias_current | tx_power |

rx_power ]

no snmp-server traps ddm [ temperature | voltage | bias_current | tx_power |
rx_power ]

Parameter

temperature ——Monitors the temperature of SFP modules inserted into the

SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the temperature of
any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold.

voltage ——Monitors the voltage of SFP modules inserted into the SFP ports

on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the voltage of any SFP module
has reached the warning or alarm threshold.

bias_current ——Monitors the bias current of SFP modules inserted into the

SFP ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the bias current of
any SFP module has reached the warning or alarm threshold.
406

tx_power ——Monitors the TX Power of SFP modules inserted into the SFP

ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the TX Power of any SFP
module has reached the warning or alarm threshold.

rx_power ——Monitors the RX Power of SFP modules inserted into the SFP
ports on the switch. The trap can be triggered when the RX Power of any SFP
module has reached the warning or alarm threshold.

User guidelines

The snmp-server traps ddm command without any parameter is used to

enable all the types of DDM traps. And the no snmp-server traps ddm

command without any parameter is used to disable all the types of DDM
traps.

For more instructions about the alarm threshold or warning threshold, refer to
Chapter 11 DDM Commands.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Example

Enable all the SNMP DDM traps for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps ddm

49.11 snmp-server traps vlan
Description

The snmp-server traps vlan command is used to enable the corresponding

VLAN traps. The command without parameter enables all SNMP VLAN traps.

To disable this function, please use no snmp-server traps vlan command. All

Syntax

VLAN traps are disabled by default.

snmp-server traps vlan [ create | delete ]
no snmp-server traps vlan [create | delete ]

Parameter

create ——Triggered when certain VLANs are created successfully.
delete ——Triggered when certain VLANs are deleted successfully.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

407

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable all SNMP extended VLAN-related traps for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps vlan
Enable VLAN-created trap only for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps vlan create

49.12 snmp-server traps security
Description

The snmp-server traps security command is used to enable the

corresponding security traps. To disable this feature, please use no

snmp-server traps security command. All security traps are disabled by

Syntax

default.

snmp-server traps security { dhcp-filter | ip-mac-binding | acl }
no snmp-server traps security { dhcp-filter | ip-mac-binding }

Parameter

dhcp-filter —— Triggered when the DHCPv4 Filter feature is enabled and the
switch receives DHCP packets from an illegal DHCP server.

ip-mac-binding —— Triggered when the ARP Inspection feature is enabled
and the switch receives an illegal ARP packet, or the IPv4 Source Guard
feature is enabled and the switch receives an illegal IP packet.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the DHCP filter trap for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps security dhcp-filter

408

49.13 snmp-server traps acl
Description

The snmp-server traps acl command is used to enable the ACL trap. To

disable this feature, please use no snmp-server traps acl command. It is

disabled by default.

The trap monitors matched ACL information, including the matched ACL ID,
rule ID and the number of the matched packets. With both this trap and the
Logging feature in ACL rule settings enabled, the switch will check the

matched ACL information every five minutes and send SNMP traps if there is

Syntax

any updated information.
snmp-server traps acl

no snmp-server traps acl

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the ACL trap for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps acl

49.14 snmp-server traps ip
Description

The snmp-server traps ip command is used to enable IP traps. To disable

this feature, please use no snmp-server traps ip command. All IP traps are

Syntax

disabled by default.

snmp-server traps ip { change | duplicate }
no snmp-server traps ip { change | duplicate }

Parameter

change —— Triggered when the DHCPv4 Filter feature is enabled and the
switch receives DHCP packets from an illegal DHCP server.

duplicate —— Triggered when the ARP Inspection feature is enabled and the

switch receives an illegal ARP packet, or the IPv4 Source Guard feature is
enabled and the switch receives an illegal IP packet.
409

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable the IP-Change trap for the switch:
T1600G-28TS(config)# snmp-server traps ip change

49.15 snmp-server traps power
Note: Only T1600G-28MPS supports this command.

Description

The snmp-server traps power command is used to enable PoE traps. The

command without parameter enables all PoE traps. To disable this feature,
please use no snmp-server traps power command. All PoE traps are

Syntax

disabled by default.

snmp-server traps power [over-max-pwr-budget | port-pwr-change |

port-pwr-deny | port-pwr-over-30w | port-pwr-overload | port-short-circuit |

thermal-shutdown ]

no snmp-server traps power [over-max-pwr-budget | port-pwr-change |

port-pwr-deny | port-pwr-over-30w | port-pwr-overload | port-short-circuit |

thermal-shutdown ]

Parameter

over-max-pwr-budget ——Triggered when the total power required by the
connected PDs exceeds the maximum power the PoE switch can supply.

port-pwr-change ——Triggered when the total power required by the

connected PDs exceeds the maximum power the PoE switch can supply.

port-pwr-deny ——Triggered when the switch powers off PDs on low-priority
PoE ports. When the total power required by the connected PDs exceeds the

system power limit, the switch will power off PDs on low-priority PoE ports to

ensure stable running of the other PDs.

port-pwr-over-30w ——Triggered when the power required by the

connected PD exceeds 30 watts.

port-pwr-overload ——Triggered when the power required by the connected

PD exceeds the maximum power the port can supply.
410

port-short-circuit ——Triggered when a short circuit is detected on a port.
thermal-shutdown ——Triggered when the PSE chip overheats. The switch
will stop supplying power in this case.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable all PoE traps for the switch:
T1600G-28MPS(config)# snmp-server traps power

49.16 snmp-server traps link-status
Description

The snmp-server traps link-status command is used to enable SNMP link

status trap for the specified port. To disable the sending of SNMP link status
trap, please use no snmp-server traps link-status command. By default, it is

Syntax

disabled.

snmp-server traps link-status
no snmp-server traps link-status

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Enable SNMP link status trap for port 3:
T1600G-28TS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/3
T1600G-28TS(config-if)# snmp-server traps link-status

411

49.17 rmon history
Description

The rmon history command is used to configure the history sample entry. To
return to the default configuration, please use no rmon history command.

RMON (Remote Monitoring), basing on SNMP architecture, functions to
monitor the network. History Group is one of the commonly used RMON

Groups. After a history group is configured, the switch collects network
statistics information periodically, based on which the management station

Syntax

can monitor network effectively.

rmon history index interface gigabitEthernet port [ interval interval ]

[ owner owner-name ] [ buckets number ]

no rmon history index

Parameter

index —— The index number of the entry, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format
of 1-3,5.

port ——The Ethernet port number.

interval —— The interval to take samplings from the port, ranging from 10 to
3600 in seconds. By default, it is 1800.

owner-name —— The owner of the history sample entry, ranging from 1 to 16
characters. By default, it is “monitor”.

number —— The maximum number of buckets desired for the RMON history
group of statistics, ranging from 1 to 130. The default is 50 buckets.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the sample port as Gi1/0/2 and the sample interval as 100 seconds
for the entry 1-3:

T1600G-28TS(config)# rmon history 1-3 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
interval 100 owner owner1

412

49.18 rmon event
Description

The rmon event command is used to configure the entries of SNMP-RMON

Event. To return to the default configuration, please use no rmon event

command. Event Group, as one of the commonly used RMON Groups, is used

Syntax

to define RMON events. Alarms occur when an event is detected.

rmon event index [ user user-name ] [ description descript ] [ type { none |

log | notify | log-notify }] [ owner owner-name ]
no rmon event index

Parameter

index —— The index number of the event entry, ranging from 1 to 12. You can

only select one entry for each command.

user-name —— The name of the User to which the event belongs, ranging

from 1 to 16 characters. By default, it is “public”.

descript —— The description of the event, ranging from 1 to 16 characters.
By default, it is empty.

type —— The event type, with none, log, notify and both options. None
indicates no processing, log indicates logging the event, notify indicates

sending trap messages to the management station, and both indicates
logging the event and sending trap messages to the management station.

owner-name —— The owner of the event entry, ranging from 1 to 16
characters. By default, it is “monitor”.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the user name of entry 1, 2, 3 and 4 as user1, the description of the
event as description1, the type of event as log and the owner of the event as
owner1:

T1600G-28TS(config)# rmon event 1-4 user user1 description description1
type log owner owner1

413

49.19 rmon alarm
Description

The rmon alarm command is used to configure SNMP-RMON Alarm
Management. To return to the default configuration, please use no rmon

alarm command. Alarm Group is one of the commonly used RMON Groups.
RMON alarm management allows monitoring the specific alarm variables.
When the value of a monitored variable exceeds the threshold, an alarm event

Syntax

is generated, which triggers the switch to act in the set way.

rmon alarm index { stats-index sindex } [ alarm-variable { revbyte | revpkt |

bpkt | mpkt | crc-lign | undersize | oversize | jabber | collision | 64 | 65-127 |

128-511 | 512-1023 | 1024-10240 }] [ s-type { absolute | delta} ]

[ rising-threshold r-hold ] [ rising-event-index r-event] [ falling-threshold

f-hold] [ falling-event-index f-event] [ a-type {rise | fall | all} ] [ owner
owner-name ] [ interval interval]
no rmon alarm index

Parameter

index —— The index number of the Alarm Management entry, ranging from 1

to 12, in the format of 1-3,5.

sindex —— Specify the statistics index.

alarm-variable —— The alarm variable. By default, the option is revbyte.
s-type —— Sample Type, which is the sampling method for the selected

variable and comparing the value against the thresholds. There are two
options, absolute and delta. Absolute indicates comparing the values directly
with the thresholds at the end of the sampling interval. Delta indicates
subtracting the last sampled value from the current value, and then

comparing the difference in the values with the threshold. By default, the
Sample Type is absolute.

r-hold —— The rising counter value that triggers the Rising Threshold alarm,

ranging from 1 to 2147483647. By default, it is 100.

r-event —— Rise Event, which is the index of the corresponding event which
will be triggered if the sampled value is larger than the Rising Threshold. It
ranges from 1 to 12.

f-hold —— The falling counter value that triggers the Falling Threshold alarm,

ranging from 1 to 2147483647. By default, it is 100.

414

f-event —— Fall Event, which is the index of the corresponding event which
will be triggered if the sampled value is lower than the Falling Threshold. It
ranges from 1 to 12.

a-type —— Alarm Type, with rise, fall and all options. Rise indicates that the

alarm event will be triggered when the sampled value exceeds the Rising

Threshold, fall indicates that the alarm event will be triggered when the

sampled value is under the Falling Threshold, and all indicates that the alarm
event will be triggered either the sampled value exceeds the Rising Threshold

or is under the Falling Threshold. By default, the Alarm Type is all.

owner-name —— The owner of the entry, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. By

default, it is monitor.

interval —— The alarm interval time, ranging from 10 to 3600 in seconds. By

default, it is 1800.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure rmon alarm entries 1-3 binding with statistics entry 2, the owners

as owner1 and the alarm intervals as 100 seconds:

T1600G-28TS(config)#rmon alarm 1-3 stats-index 2 owner owner1 interval
100

49.20 rmon statistics
Description

The rmon statistics command is used to configure the entries of
SNMP-RMON statistics. To delete the corresponding entry, please use no

Syntax

rmon statistics command. The maximum supported entries are 1000.

rmon statistics index interface gigabitEthernet port [ owner owner-name]

[ status { underCreation | valid }]

no rmon statistics index

Parameter

index —— The index number of the statistics entry, ranging from 1 to 65535,
in the format of 1-3,5.

415

port —— The statistics port number, in the format of 1/0/1.

owner-name —— The creator of the event entry, ranging from 1 to 16
characters. By default, it is “monitor”.

status

—— The status of the statistics entry, either “underCreation” or

“valid”. “underCreation” means this entry won’t take effect until it is modified
to “valid”; “valid” means this entry takes effect immediately after it is created.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Configure the statistics entries 1-3 with the statistics port as 1/0/1, owner as

owner1 and status as valid:

T1600G-28TS(config)#rmon statistics 1-3 interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/1
owner owner1 status valid

49.21 show snmp-server
Description

The show snmp-server command is used to display SNMP configuration

Syntax

globally.

show snmp-server

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display SNMP configuration globally:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server

49.22 show snmp-server view
Description

The show snmp-server view command is used to display the View table.
416

Syntax

show snmp-server view

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the View table:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server view

49.23 show snmp-server group
Description
Syntax

The show snmp-server group command is used to display the Group table.
show snmp-server group

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the Group table:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server group

49.24 show snmp-server user
Description
Syntax

The show snmp-server user command is used to display the User table.
show snmp-server user

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.
417

Example

Display the User table:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server user

49.25 show snmp-server community
Description

The show snmp-server community command is used to display the

Syntax

Community table.

show snmp-server community

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the Community table:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server community

49.26 show snmp-server host
Description
Syntax

The show snmp-server host command is used to display the Host table.
show snmp-server host

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the Host table:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server host

418

49.27 show snmp-server engineID
Description

The show snmp-server engineID command is used to display the engineID

Syntax

of the SNMP.

show snmp-server engineID

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the engineID:
T1600G-28TS# show snmp-server engineID

49.28 show rmon history
Description

The show rmon history command is used to display the configuration of the

Syntax

history sample entry.

show rmon history [ index ]

Parameter

index —— The index number of the entry selected to display the

configuration, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3, 5. You can select
more than one entry for each command. By default, the configuration of all
history sample entries is displayed.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the configuration of all history sample entries:
T1600G-28TS# show rmon history

419

49.29 show rmon event
Description

The show rmon event command is used to display the configuration of

Syntax

SNMP-RMON Event.

show rmon event [ index ]

Parameter

index —— The index number of the entry selected to display the

configuration, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3, 5. You can select
more than one entry for each command. By default, the configuration of all
SNMP-RMON enabled entries is displayed.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the Event configuration of entry1-4:
T1600G-28TS# show rmon event 1-4

49.30 show rmon alarm
Description

The show rmon alarm command is used to display the configuration of the

Syntax

Alarm Management entry.

show rmon alarm [ index ]

Parameter

index —— The index number of the entry selected to display the

configuration, ranging from 1 to 12, in the format of 1-3, 5. You can select
more than one entry for each command. By default, the configuration of all
Alarm Management entries is displayed.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

420

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the configuration of the Alarm Management entry 1-2:
T1600G-28TS# show rmon alarm 1-2

49.31 show rmon statistics
Description

The show rmon statistics command is used to display the configuration of

Syntax

the specified statistics entry.

show rmon statistics [ index ]

Parameter

index —— The index number of the statistics entry selected to display the
configuration, ranging from 1 to 65535. By default, the configuration of all
statistics entries is displayed.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement

Only Admin level users have access to these commands.

Example

Display the configuration of the statistics entry 1:
T1600G-28TS#show rmon statistics 1

421

Chapter 50 PoE Commands
Note: Only T1600G-28MPS supports PoE function.
PoE (Power over Ethernet) technology describes a system to transmit electrical power along
with data to remote devices over standard twisted-pair cable in an Ethernet network. It is

especially useful for supplying power to IP telephones, wireless LAN access points, cameras
and so on.

50.1

power inline consumption (global)
Description

The power inline consumption command is used to configure the max

Syntax

power the PoE switch can supply globally.

power inline consumption power-limit

Parameter

power-limit ——The max power the PoE switch can supply, ranging from 1 to
384w. By default, the value is 384.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Configure the max power the PoE switch can supply as 160w:
T1600G-28PS(config)# power inline consumption 160

50.2

power profile
Description

The power profile command is used to create a PoE profile for the switch. To

delete the configured PoE profile configuration, please use no power profile
command. PoE Profile is a short cut for the configuration of the PoE port. In a

PoE profile, the PoE status, PoE priority and power limit are configured. You
can specify a PoE profile for each PoE port individually.
422

Syntax

power profile name [supply {enable | disable} [priority {low | middle | high}

[consumption { power-limit | auto | class1 | class2 | class3 | class4 } ] ] ]
no power profile name

Parameter

name —— The PoE profile name, ranging from 1 to 16 characters. If the name
being assigned contains spaces then put it inside double quotes.

supply —— The PoE status of the port in the profile. By default, the PoE
status is “enable”.

priority —— The PoE priority of the port in the profile. The priority levels

include “high”, “middle” and “low” in descending order. When the supply

power exceeds the system power limit, the PD linked to the port with lower
priority will be disconnected. By default, the PoE priority is “low”.

consumption —— The max power the port in the profile can supply, with five

options: “power-limit”, “auto”, ”class1”, “class2”, “class3” and “class4”.

“Power-limit” indicates you can manually enter a value ranging from 1 to 300.
The value is in the unit of 0.1 watt. For instance, if you want to configure the

max power as 5w, you should enter 50. “Auto” indicates the value is assigned

automatically by the PoE switch. “Class1” represents 4w. “Class2” represents
7w. “Class3” represents 15.4w. “Class4” represents 30w.

Command Mode

Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Create a PoE profile named “IP Camera” whose PoE status is “enable”, PoE
priority is “low” and the power limit is “5w”:
T1600G-28PS(config)# power profile

“IP Camera” supply enable priority

low consumption 50

50.3

power inline consumption (interface)
Description

The power inline consumption command is used to configure the power limit
the corresponding port can supply.
423

Syntax

power inline consumption { power-limit | auto | class1 | class2 | class3 |

class4 }

Parameter

power-limit —— The max power the port in the profile can supply, with five
options: “power-limit”, “auto”, ”class1”, “class2”, “class3” and “class4”.

“Power-limit” indicates you can manually enter a value ranging from 1 to 300.
The value is in the unit of 0.1 watt. For instance, if you want to configure the

max power as 5w, you should enter 50. “Auto” indicates the value is assigned
automatically by the PoE switch. “Class1” represents 4w. “Class2” represents
7w. “Class3” represents 15.4w. “Class4” represents 30w.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Configure the power limit as “5w” for port 2:
T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline consumption 50

50.4

power inline priority
Description

The power inline priority command is used to configure the PoE priority for

Syntax

the corresponding port

power inline priority { low | middle | high }

Parameter

priority —— The PoE priority of the port. The priority levels include “high”,

“middle” and “low” in descending order. When the supply power exceeds the

system power limit, the PD linked to the port with lower priority will be
disconnected. By default, the priority level is “low”.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
424

gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Configure the PoE priority as “low” for port 2:
T1600G-52PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-52PS(config-if)# power inline priority low

50.5

power inline supply
Description

The power inline supply command is used to configure the PoE status of the

Syntax

corresponding port.

power inline supply { enable | disable }

Parameter

enable | disable —— The PoE status of the port. By default, the PoE status is
“enable”.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Enable the PoE feature for port 2:
T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline supply enable

50.6

power inline profile
Description

The power inline profile command is used to bind a PoE profile to the

corresponding port. To cancel the bind relation, please use no power inline
profile command.

425

Syntax

power inline profile name
no power inline profile

Parameter

name —— The name of the PoE profile to be bound to the port. If the name
being assigned contains spaces then put it inside double quotes.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Bind the PoE profile named “IP Camera” to port 2:
T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline profile “IP Camera”

50.7

power inline time-range
Description

The power inline time-range command is used to bind a PoE time-range to

the corresponding port. To cancel the bind relation, please use no power

Syntax

inline time-range command.

power inline time-range name

no power inline time-range

Parameter

name —— The name of the PoE time-range to be bound to the port.

Command Mode

Interface Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Bind the PoE time-range named “tRange2" to port 2:

426

T1600G-28PS(config)# interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/2
T1600G-28PS(config-if)# power inline time-range tRange2

50.8

show power inline
Description

The show power inline command is used to display the global PoE

Syntax

information of the system.

show power inline

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the PoE information of the system:
T1600G-28PS# show power inline

50.9

show power inline configuration interface
Description

The show power inline configuration interface command is used to display

Syntax

the PoE configuration of the certain port.

show power inline configuration interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the PoE configuration of all ports:
427

T1600G-28PS# show power inline configuration interface

50.10 show power inline information interface
Description

The show power inline information command is used to display the PoE

Syntax

information of the certain port.

show power inline information interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameter

port —— The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the PoE information of all ports:
T1600G-28PS# show power inline information interface

50.11 show power profile
Description
Syntax

The show power profile command is used to display the defined PoE profile.
show power profile

Command Mode

Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example

Display the defined PoE profile:
T1600G-28PS# show power profile

428

Chapter 51 ARP Inspection Commands
ARP (Address Resolution Protocol) Detect function is to protect the switch from the ARP
cheating, such as the Network Gateway Spoofing and Man-In-The-Middle Attack, etc.

51.1

ip arp inspection
Description
The ip arp inspection command is used to enable the ARP Detection
function globally. To disable the ARP Detection function, please use no ip arp
detection command.

Syntax
ip arp inspection
no ip arp inspection

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the ARP Detection function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection

51.2

ip arp inspection validate
Description
The ip arp inspection validate command is used to enable the switch to
check whether the reveided ARP packet is illegal. To disable,the feature
please use no ip arp detection validate command.

Syntax
ip arp inspection validate { src-mac | dst-mac | ip }
no ip arp inspection validate { src-mac | dst-mac | ip }
429

Syntax
src-mac —— Enable the switch to check whether the source MAC address
and the sender MAC address are the same when receiving an ARP packet. If
not, the ARP packet will be discarded.

dst-mac —— Enable the switch to check whether the sender IP address of all

ARP packets and the target IP address of ARP reply packets are legal. The
illegal packets will be discarded.

ip —— Enable or disable the switch to check whether the sender IP address
of all ARP packets and the target IP address of ARP reply packets are legal.
The illegal packets will be discarded.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the switch to check whether the source MAC address and the sender
MAC address are the same when receiving an ARP packet

T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection validate src-mac

51.3

ip arp inspection vlan
Description
The ip arp inspection vlan command is used to enable the ARP Detection
function on VLANs. To disable the ARP Detection function on VLANs, please
use no ip arp detection vlan command.

Syntax
ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list

no ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list

Syntax
vlan-list —— Enter the VLAN ID. The format is 1,5-9.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode
430

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the ARP Detection function on VLAN 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection vlan 2

51.4

ip arp inspection vlan logging
Description
The ip arp inspection vlan logging command is used to enable the Log

function on the specific VLAN. To disable the Log function on the VLAN,
please use no ip arp detection vlan logging command.

Syntax
ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list logging

no ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list logging

Syntax
vlan-list —— Enter the VLAN ID. The format is 1,5-9.
logging —— Enable the Log feature to make the switch generate a log when
an ARP packet is discarded.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Enable the log feature on VLAN 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ip arp inspection vlan 2 logging

431

51.5

ip arp inspection trust
Description
The ip arp inspection trust command is used to configure the port for which
the ARP Detect function is unnecessary as the Trusted Port. To clear the

Trusted Port list, please use no ip arp detection trust command .The specific

ports, such as up-linked port and routing port and LAG port, should be set as
Trusted Port. To ensure the normal communication of the switch, please
configure the ARP Trusted Port before enabling the ARP Detect function.

Syntax
ip arp inspection trust
no ip arp inspection trust

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-5 as the Trusted Port:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ip arp inspection trust

51.6

ip arp inspection limit-rate
Description
The ip arp inspection limit-rate command is used to configure the ARP

speed of a specified port. To restore to the default speed, please use no ip
arp inspection limit-rate command.

Syntax
ip arp inspection limit-rate value
no ip arp inspection limit-rate

432

Parameter
value ——The value to specify the maximum amount of the received ARP

packets per second, ranging from 1 to 300 in pps(packet/second). By default,
the value is 100.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the maximum amount of the received ARP packets per second as
50 pps for Gigabit Ethernet port 5:

T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip arp inspection limit-rate 50

51.7

ip arp inspection burst-interval
Description
The ip arp inspection burst-interval command is used to configure the burst

interval of a specified port. To restore to the default speed, please use no ip
arp inspection burst-interval command.

Syntax
ip arp inspection burst-interval value
no ip arp inspection burst-interval

Parameter
value —— Specify a time range. If the speed of received ARP packets in this
time range reaches the limit for this time range, the port will be shut down.
The valid values are from 1 to 15 seconds, and the default value is 1 second.

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

433

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Configure the burst interval as 2 seconds for Gigabit Ethernet port 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip arp inspection burst-interval 2

51.8

ip arp inspection recover
Description
The ip arp inspection recover command is used to restore a port to the ARP
transmit status from the ARP filter status.

Syntax
ip arp inspection recover

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet)

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Restore Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/5 to the ARP transmit status:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface gigabitEthernet 1/0/5
T1600G-28TS(config-if)#ip arp inspection recover

51.9

show ip arp inspection
Description
The show ip arp inspection command is used to display the ARP detection
global configuration including the enable/disable status and the Trusted Port
list.

434

Syntax
show ip arp inspection

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the ARP detection configuration globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection

51.10 show ip arp inspection interface
Description
The show ip arp inspection interface command is used to display the

interface configuration of ARP detection.

Syntax
show ip arp inspection interface [ gigabitEthernet port ]

Parameter
port ——The Ethernet port number.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/1
Display the configuration of all Ethernet ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection interface

435

51.11 show ip arp inspection vlan
Description
The show ip arp inspection vlan command is used to display the VLAN
configuration of ARP detection.

Syntax
show ip arp inspection vlan

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the ARP Inspection configuration of VLAN:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection vlan

51.12 show ip arp inspection statistics
Description
The show ip arp inspection statistics command is used to display the

number of the illegal ARP packets received.

Syntax
show ip arp inspection statistics

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the number of the illegal ARP packets received:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ip arp inspection statistics

436

51.13 clear ip arp inspection statistics
Description
The clear ip arp inspection statistics command is used to clear the statistic
of the illegal ARP packets received.

Syntax
clear ip arp inspection statistics

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin, Operator and Power User level users have access to these
commands.

Example
Clear the statistic of the illegal ARP packets received:
T1600G-28TS(config)#clear ip arp inspection statistics

437

Chapter 52 ND Detection Commands
The ND Detection feature allows the switch to detect the ND packets based on the binding

entries in the IPv6-MAC Binding Table and filter out the illegal ND packets. Before configuring

ND Detection, complete IPv6-MAC Binding configuration. For details, refer to IPv6-MAC
Binding Configurations.

52.1

ipv6 nd detection
Description
The ipv6 nd detection command is used to enable the ND Detection function
globally. To disable the ND Detection function, please use no ipv6 nd
detection command.

Syntax
ipv6 nd detection
no ipv6 nd detection

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Example
Enable the ND Detection function globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd detection

52.2

ipv6 nd detection vlan
Description
The ipv6 nd detection vlan command is used to enable ND Detection

function on a specified VLAN. To disable ND Detection function on this VLAN,
please use no ipv6 nd detection vlan command.

Syntax
ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range

no ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range

438

Parameter
vlan-range ——Enter the vlan range in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Example
Enable the ND Detection function on VLAN 1,4,6-7:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd detection vlan 1,4,6-7

52.3

ipv6 nd detection vlan logging
Description
The ipv6 nd detection vlan logging command is used to enable Log function

on a specified VLAN. To disable Log function on this VLAN, please use no
ipv6 nd detection vlan logging command.

Syntax
ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range logging

no ipv6 nd detection vlan vlan-range logging

Parameter
vlan-range ——Enter the vlan range in the format of 1-3, 5.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Example
Enable the Log function on VLAN 1,4,6-7:
T1600G-28TS(config)#ipv6 nd detection vlan 1,4,6-7 logging

52.4

ipv6 nd detection trust
Description
The ipv6 nd detection trust command is used to configure the port for which
the ND Detection function is unnecessary as the Trusted Port. To clear the
Trusted Port list, please use no ipv6 nd detection trust command .The

specific port, such as up-linked port, routing port and LAG port, should be set
439

as Trusted Port. To ensure the normal communication of the switch, please

configure the ND Detection Trusted Port before enabling the ND Detection
function.

Syntax
Ipv6 nd detection trust
no ipv6 nd detection trust

Command Mode
Interface Configuration Mode (interface gigabitEthernet / interface range
gigabitEthernet/ interface port-channel / interface range port-channel)

Example
Configure the Gigabit Ethernet ports 1/0/2-5 as the Trusted Port:
T1600G-28TS(config)#interface range gigabitEthernet 1/0/2-5
T1600G-28TS(config-if-range)#ipv6 nd detection trust

52.5

show ipv6 nd detection
Description
The show ipv6 nd detection command is used to display the ND detection

global configuration including the enable/disable status.

Syntax
show ipv6 nd detection

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Example
Display the ND Detection configuration globally:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection

52.6

show ipv6 nd detection interface
Description
The show ipv6 nd detection interface command is used to display the
interface configuration of ND Detection.
440

Syntax
show ipv6 nd detection interface[ fastEthernet port | gigabitEthernet port |
ten-gigabitEthernet port | port-channel port-channel-id ]

Parameter
port ——The Ethernet port number.
port-channel-id —— The ID of the port channel.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Example
Display the configuration of Gigabit Ethernet port 1/0/1:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection interface gigabitEthernet
1/0/1
Display the configuration of all Ethernet ports:
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection interface

52.7

show ipv6 nd detection vlan
Description
The show ipv6 nd detection vlan command is used to display the VLAN
configuration of ND Detection.

Syntax
show ipv6 nd detection vlan

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Example
Display the ipv6 ND Detection configuration of VLAN.
T1600G-28TS(config)#show ipv6 nd detection vlan

441

Chapter 53

System Log Commands

The log information will record the settings and operation of the switch respectively for you to
monitor operation status and diagnose malfunction.

53.1

logging buffer
Description
The logging buffer command is used to store the system log messages to an

internal buffer. To disable the log buffer function, please use the no logging
buffer command. Local Log is the system log information saved in the switch.
It has two output channels, that is, it can be saved to two different positions,

log buffer and log flash memory. The log buffer indicates the RAM for saving
system log and the information in the log buffer can be got by show logging
buffer command. It will be lost when the switch is restarted.

Syntax
logging buffer
no logging buffer

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable the system log buffer:
T1600G-28TS(config)#logging buffer

53.2

logging buffer level
Description
The logging buffer level command is used to configure the severity level and

the status of the configuration input to the log buffer. To return to the default
configuration, please use no logging buffer level command.

442

Syntax
logging buffer level level
no logging buffer level

Parameter
level —— Severity level of the log information output to each channel. There

are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher

priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will be

output. By default, it is 6 indicating that the log information with level 0-6 will

be saved in the log buffer.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Set the severity level as 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)#logging buffer level 5

53.3

logging file flash
Description
The logging file flash command is used to store the log messages in a file in

the flash on the switch. To disable the log file flash function, please use no
logging file flash command. This function is disabled by default. The log file

flash indicates the flash sector for saving system log. The information in the
log file of the flash will not be lost after the switch is restarted and can be got
by the show logging flash command.

Syntax
logging file flash
no logging file flash

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

443

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable the log file flash function:
T1600G-28TS(config)#logging file flash

53.4

logging file flash frequency
Description
The logging file flash frequency command is used to specify the frequency
to synchronize the system log file in the log buffer to the flash. To resume the

default synchronizing frequency, please use the no logging file flash
frequency command.

Syntax
logging file flash frequency { periodic periodic | immediate }
no logging file flash frequency

Parameter
periodic —— The frequency to synchronize the system log file in the log

buffer to the flash, ranging from 1 to 48 hours. By default, the synchronization
process takes place every 24 hours.
immediate

—— The system log file in the buffer will be synchronized to the

flash immediately. This option will reduce the life of the flash and is not
recommended.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Specify the log file synchronization frequency as 10 hours:
T1600G-28TS(config)#logging file flash frequency periodic10

444

53.5

logging file flash level
Description
The logging file flash level command is used to specify the system log

message severity level. Messages will a severity level equal to or higher than
this value will be stored to the flash. To restore to the default level, please use
no logging file flash level command.

Syntax
logging file flash level level
no logging file flash level

Parameter
level —— Severity level of the log message. There are 8 severity levels

marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the higher priority. Only the log

with the same or smaller severity level value will be saved to the flash. By
default, it is 3 indicating that the log message marked with 0~3 will be saved
in the log flash.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Save the log messages with their severities equal or higher than 7 to the
flash :

T1600G-28TS(config)#logging file flash level 7

53.6

logging host index
Description
The logging host index command is used to configure the Log Host. To clear

the configuration of the specified Log Host, please use no logging host

index command. Log Host is to receive the system log from other devices.
You can remotely monitor the settings and operation status of other devices
through the log host.

445

Syntax
logging host index idx host-ip level

no logging host index idx

Parameter
idx —— The index of the log host. The switch supports 4 log hosts at most.
host-ip —— The IP for the log host.

level —— The severity level of the log information sent to each log host.

There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the

higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will
be sent to the corresponding log host. By default, it is 6 indicating that the log
information marked with 0~6 will be sent to the log host.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Enable log host 2 and set its IP address as 192.168.0.148, the level 5:
T1600G-28TS(config)# logging host index 2 192.168.0.148 5

53.7

logging console
Description
The logging console command is used to send the system logs to the

console port. To disable logging to the console, please use no logging
console command. This function is enabled by default.

Syntax
logging console
no logging console

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.
446

Example
Enable logging to the console port:
T1600G-28TS(config)# logging console

53.8

logging console level
Description
The logging console level command is used to limit messages logged to the

console port. System logs no higher than the set threshold level will be

displayed on the console port. To restore the threshold level to default value,
please use no logging console level command.

Syntax
logging console level level
no logging monitor level

Parameter
level —— Severity level of the log information output to the console port.
There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the

higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will
be output to the terminal devices. By default, it is 5 indicating that all the log
information between level 0-5 will be output to the terminal devices.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Output the log information with severity levels between 0-7 to the console
port:

T1600G-28TS(config)# logging console level 7

447

53.9

logging monitor
Description
The logging monitor command is used to display the system logs on the
terminal devices. To disable logging to the terminal, please use no logging
monitor command. This function is enabled by default.

Syntax
logging monitor
no logging monitor

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Disable logging to the terminal devices:
T1600G-28TS(config)# no logging monitor

53.10 logging monitor level
Description
The logging monitor level command is used to limit messages logged to the

terminal devices. System logs no higher than the set threshold level will be
displayed on the terminal devices. To restore the threshold level to default
value, please use no logging monitor level command.

Syntax
logging monitor level level
no logging monitor level

Parameter
level —— Severity level of the log information output to the terminal devices.

There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7. The smaller value has the

higher priority. Only the log with the same or smaller severity level value will

448

be output to the terminal devices. By default, it is 5 indicating that all the log
information between level 0-5 will be output to the terminal devices.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Output the log information with severity levels between 0-7 to the terminal
devices:

T1600G-28TS(config)# logging monitor level 7

53.11 clear logging
Description
The clear logging command is used to clear the information in the log buffer

and log file.

Syntax
clear logging [ buffer | flash ]

Parameter
buffer | flash —The output channels: buffer and flash. Clear the information of

the two channels, by default.

Command Mode
Global Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
Only Admin and Operator level users have access to these commands.

Example
Clear the information in the log file:
T1600G-28TS(config)# clear logging buffer

449

53.12 show logging local-config
Description
The show logging local-config command is used to display the configuration

of the Local Log output to the console, the terminal, the log buffer and the log
file.

Syntax
show logging local-config

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the configuration of the Local Log:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging local-config

53.13 show logging loghost
Description
The show logging loghost command is used to display the configuration of
the log host.

Syntax
show logging loghost [ index ]

Parameter
index ——The index of the log host whose configuration will be displayed,
ranging from 1 to 4. Display the configuration of all the log hosts by default.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

450

Example
Display the configuration of the log host 2:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging loghost 2

53.14 show logging buffer
Description
The show logging buffer command is used to display the log information in

the log buffer according to the severity level.

Syntax
show logging buffer [ level level ]

Parameter
level —— Severity level. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7.

The information of levels with priority not lower than the select level will
display. Display all the log information in the log buffer by default.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the log information from level 0 to level 5 in the log buffer:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging buffer level 5

53.15 show logging flash
Description
The show logging flash command is used to display the log information in
the log file according to the severity level.

Syntax
show logging flash [ level level ]

451

Parameter
level —— Severity level. There are 8 severity levels marked with values 0-7.

The information of levels with priority not lower than the select level will
display. Display all the log information in the log file by default.

Command Mode
Privileged EXEC Mode and Any Configuration Mode

Privilege Requirement
None.

Example
Display the log information with the level marked 0~3 in the log file:
T1600G-28TS(config)# show logging flash level 3

452



Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.5
Linearized                      : No
Create Date                     : 2017:12:05 16:16:02+08:00
Modify Date                     : 2017:12:05 16:19:06+08:00
Subject                         : 
Tagged PDF                      : Yes
XMP Toolkit                     : Adobe XMP Core 5.4-c005 78.147326, 2012/08/23-13:03:03
Metadata Date                   : 2017:12:05 16:19:06+08:00
Creator Tool                    : Acrobat PDFMaker 11 Word 版
Document ID                     : uuid:6317d31a-a7f6-4f75-80bb-719a918451e4
Instance ID                     : uuid:68f194b3-21eb-4a40-b690-619766135f42
Format                          : application/pdf
Title                           : 
Description                     : 
Creator                         : 
Producer                        : Adobe PDF Library 11.0
Page Layout                     : OneColumn
Page Mode                       : UseOutlines
Page Count                      : 473
Warning                         : [Minor] Ignored duplicate Info dictionary
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools

Navigation menu